Remove remaining references to FTD2XX driver
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @section Interface Drivers
2371
2372 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2373 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2374 available at run time.
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2377 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2378 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2379 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2382 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2383 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2384 @end deffn
2385
2386 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2387 Displays status of RTCK option.
2388 Optionally sets that option first.
2389 @end deffn
2390 @end deffn
2391
2392 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2393 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2394 This has one driver-specific command:
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2397 Logs some status
2398 @end deffn
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2402 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2403 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2404 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2405 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2406 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2410 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2411 or v2 (USB bulk).
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2428 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2429
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2432 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2433 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2434 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2435 @end itemize
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2439 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2440 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2441 interface string or for user class interface.
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2445 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2446 @end deffn
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2450 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2454 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2458 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2459 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2460
2461 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2462 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2463
2464 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2465 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2466
2467 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2468 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2469 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2470 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2471 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2472 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2473
2474 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2475 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2476 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2477 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2478 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2479
2480 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2481 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2482 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2483 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2484
2485 @itemize @minus
2486 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2487 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2488 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2489 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2491 switching data and direction as necessary
2492 @end itemize
2493
2494 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2495 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2498 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2499 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2500 @example
2501 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2502 @end example
2503 @end deffn
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2506 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2507 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2508 during device selection.
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi serial} serial-number
2512 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2513 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2514 is connected to the host.
2515 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2516 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2517 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2521 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2522 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2526 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2527 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2528 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2529 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2530 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2531 and initially asserted reset signals.
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2535 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2536 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2537 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2538 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2539 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2540 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2541 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2542 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2543 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2544 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2545
2546 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2547 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2548 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2549 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2550 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2551 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2552
2553 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2554 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2555 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2556 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2557 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2558 are always driven by the FTDI.
2559
2560 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2561 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2562 @var{name}.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2566 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2567 @itemize @minus
2568 @item @option{0}, drive low
2569 @item @option{1}, drive high
2570 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2571 @end itemize
2572 @end deffn
2573
2574 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2575 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2579 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2580
2581 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2582 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2583 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2584 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2587 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2588 @end itemize
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2592 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2593
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2597 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2598 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2599 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2600
2601 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2604 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2605 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2606 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2607 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2608 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2609 @end itemize
2610
2611 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2612 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2613 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2614 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2615 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2616 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2617 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2618 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2619
2620 FT232R
2621 @itemize @minus
2622 @item bit 7 - RI
2623 @item bit 6 - DCD
2624 @item bit 5 - DSR
2625 @item bit 4 - DTR
2626 @item bit 3 - CTS
2627 @item bit 2 - RTS
2628 @item bit 1 - RXD
2629 @item bit 0 - TXD
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2633 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2636 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2637 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r serial_desc} @var{serial}
2641 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2642 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2643 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2647 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2648 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2652 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2656 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2660 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2664 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2668 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2672 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2676 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2677 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2678 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2679 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2680 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2681 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2682 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2683 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2684 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2690 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2691 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2692 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2693
2694 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2695 processors which are being simulated.
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2698 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2699 sockets instead of TCP.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2703 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2704 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2708 something like:
2709
2710 @example
2711 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2712 remote_bitbang port 3335
2713 remote_bitbang host foobar
2714 @end example
2715
2716 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2717 named mysocket:
2718
2719 @example
2720 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2721 remote_bitbang port 0
2722 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2723 @end example
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2727 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2728 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2729 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2732 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2733 default values are used.
2734 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2735 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2736 @example
2737 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2738 @end example
2739 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2740 @example
2741 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2742 @end example
2743 @end deffn
2744
2745 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2746 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2747 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2748 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2749 target board.
2750
2751 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2752 @example
2753 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2754 reset_config srst_only
2755 @end example
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2759 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2760 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2761 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2765 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2766 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2772 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2773 This has one driver-specific command:
2774
2775 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2776 Display either the address of the I/O port
2777 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2778 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2779 This is a write-once setting.
2780 @end deffn
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2784 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2785 transports.
2786
2787 @quotation Compatibility Note
2788 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2789 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2790 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2791 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2792 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2793 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2794 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2795 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2796 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2797 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2798 @end quotation
2799
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2801 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2802 states.
2803 @end deffn
2804 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2805 Display free device internal memory.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2808 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2809 command version.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2812 Display the device configuration.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2815 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2816 power state.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2819 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2822 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2823 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2824 IP configuration.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2827 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2828 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2831 Reset the current configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2834 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2837 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2838 pairs.
2839
2840 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2841 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2842 @example
2843 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2844 @end example
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2847 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2851 @example
2852 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2853 77a90000
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2857 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2858 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2859 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2860 the serial number instead, if possible.
2861
2862 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2865 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2866 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2867
2868 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @end deffn
2871
2872 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2873 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2874 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2875 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2876 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2877 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2878 configuration script.
2879
2880 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2881 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2882 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2883 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2884 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2885
2886 Known limitations:
2887 @itemize @bullet
2888 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2889 and 2.7 MHz.
2890 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2891 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2892 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2893 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2894 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2895 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2896 communications with the target.
2897 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2898 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2899 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2900 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2901 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2902 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2903 @end itemize
2904
2905 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2906 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2907 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2908 @end deffn
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2911 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2912 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2916 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2917 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2918 target as a side-effect.
2919 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2923 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2924 version, and target voltage.
2925 @end deffn
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2929 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2930 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2931 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2932 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2933
2934 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2935 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2936 This is a write-once setting.
2937 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2938
2939 @itemize @minus
2940 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2941 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2942 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2943 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2944 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2945 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2946 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2947 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2948 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2949 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2950 some versions of
2951 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2952 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2953 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2954 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2955 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2956 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2957 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2958 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2959 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2960 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2961 @end itemize
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2965 Display either the address of the I/O port
2966 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2967 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2968 This is a write-once setting.
2969
2970 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2971 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2972 you may encounter a problem.
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2976 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2977 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2978 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2979 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2980 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2981
2982 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2983 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2984 @quotation Tip
2985 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2986 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2987 @example
2988 > parport toggling_time 1000
2989 > adapter speed 500
2990 @end example
2991 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2992 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2993 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2994 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2995 large set of samples.
2996 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2997 @example
2998 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2999 @end example
3000 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3001 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3002
3003 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3004 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3005 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3006 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3007 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3008 be conservative.
3009 @end quotation
3010 @end deffn
3011
3012 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3013 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3014 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3015 @end deffn
3016
3017 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3018 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3019
3020 @example
3021 adapter driver parport
3022 parport port 0x278
3023 parport cable wiggler
3024 @end example
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3028 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3029 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3030 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3031 @end deffn
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3035 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3036 @end deffn
3037
3038 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3039 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3043 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3044
3045 @quotation Note
3046 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3047 which are not currently documented here.
3048 @end quotation
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @anchor{hla_interface}
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3053 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3054 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3055 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3056
3057 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3058 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3059 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3060 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3061 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3062 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3063
3064 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3065 Currently Not Supported.
3066 @end deffn
3067
3068 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3069 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3073 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3077 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3078 @end deffn
3079
3080 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3081 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3082 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3083
3084 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3085 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3086 ST-LINK server software module}.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3090 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3091 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3092 @end deffn
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3096 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3097 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3098 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3099 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3100
3101 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3102 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3103 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3104 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3105
3106 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3107 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3108
3109 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3110 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3111 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3112
3113 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3114 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3115 ST-LINK server software module}.
3116
3117 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3118 @end deffn
3119
3120 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3121 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3122 @end deffn
3123
3124 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3125 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3129 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3130 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3131
3132 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3133 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3134 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3135 the target's supply voltage.
3136 @example
3137 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3138 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3139 @end example
3140 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3141 @example
3142 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3143 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3144 3.24891518738
3145 @end example
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3150 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3154 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3158 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3159 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3160 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3161 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3162
3163 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3164 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3165 XDS110 found will be used.
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3169 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3170 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3171 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3172 @end deffn
3173
3174 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3175 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3176 version).
3177 @end deffn
3178 @end deffn
3179
3180 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3181 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3182 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3183 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3184 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3185
3186 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3187
3188 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3189 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3190
3191 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3192 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3193
3194 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197 @end deffn
3198
3199 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3200 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3201 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3202
3203 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3204 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3205 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3206 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3207 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3208 configuration on exit.
3209
3210 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3211 pinout.
3212
3213 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3214 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3215 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3216 individually.
3217 @end deffn
3218
3219 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3220 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3221 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3222 @end deffn
3223
3224 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3225 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3226 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3230 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3231 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3232 @end deffn
3233
3234 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3235 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3236 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3237 @end deffn
3238
3239 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3240 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3241 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3242 @end deffn
3243
3244 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3245 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3246 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3247 @end deffn
3248
3249 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3250 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3251 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3252 @end deffn
3253
3254 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3255 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3256 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3257 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3261 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3265 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3269 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3270 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3274 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3275 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3276 list can be found in the
3277 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3278 @end deffn
3279
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3283 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3284 of the one which is most popular.
3285
3286 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3287
3288 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3289 pinout.
3290
3291 @end deffn
3292
3293
3294 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3295 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3296 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3297
3298 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3299 @end deffn
3300
3301
3302 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3303 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3304 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3305
3306 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3307 @end deffn
3308
3309
3310 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3311 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3312 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3313
3314 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3315 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3316 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3317
3318 @itemize @minus
3319 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3320 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3321 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3322 @end itemize
3323 @end deffn
3324
3325 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3326 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3327 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3328 @end deffn
3329 @end deffn
3330
3331
3332 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3333 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3334 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3335 DPI server interface.
3336
3337 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3338 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3339 @end deffn
3340
3341 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3342 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3343 @end deffn
3344 @end deffn
3345
3346
3347 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3348
3349 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3350 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3351
3352 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3353 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3354
3355 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3356 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3357 @example
3358 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3359 @end example
3360 @end deffn
3361
3362 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3363 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3364 @example
3365 buspirate speed normal
3366 @end example
3367 @end deffn
3368
3369 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3370 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3371 @itemize @minus
3372 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3373 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3374 @end itemize
3375 For example:
3376 @example
3377 buspirate mode normal
3378 @end example
3379 @end deffn
3380
3381 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3382 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3383 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3384 For example:
3385 @example
3386 buspirate pullup 0
3387 @end example
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3391 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3392 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3393 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3394 @example
3395 buspirate vreg 0
3396 @end example
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3400 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3401 @end deffn
3402 @example
3403 buspirate led 1
3404 @end example
3405
3406 @end deffn
3407
3408
3409 @section Transport Configuration
3410 @cindex Transport
3411 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3412 and the debug adapter you are using,
3413 several transports may be available to
3414 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3415 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3416 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3417 version of OpenOCD.
3418 @end deffn
3419
3420 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3421 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3422
3423 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3424 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3425 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3426 adapter's driver).
3427
3428 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3429 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3430 supported by the debug adapter.
3431
3432 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3433 transport, if any.
3434 @end deffn
3435
3436 @subsection JTAG Transport
3437 @cindex JTAG
3438 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3439 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3440 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3441 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3442 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3443 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3444
3445 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3446 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3447 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3448 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3449 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3450
3451 @subsection SWD Transport
3452 @cindex SWD
3453 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3454 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3455 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3456 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3457 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3458 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3459 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3460
3461 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3462 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3463 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3464 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3465 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3466
3467 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3468 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3469 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3470 expected to change.
3471 @end deffn
3472 @deffn {Command} {swd wcr trn prescale}
3473 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3474 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3475 No parameters: displays current settings.
3476 @end deffn
3477
3478 @subsection SPI Transport
3479 @cindex SPI
3480 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3481 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3482 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3483 solution for flash programming.
3484
3485 @anchor{swimtransport}
3486 @subsection SWIM Transport
3487 @cindex SWIM
3488 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3489 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3490 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3491 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3492
3493 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3494
3495 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3496
3497 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3498 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3499 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3500 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3501 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3502
3503 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3504 @section JTAG Speed
3505 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3506 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3507 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3508 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3509 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3510 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3511 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3512 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3513 power management software that may be active.
3514
3515 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3516 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3517 target event handler.
3518 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3519 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3520 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3521 sets up those clocks).
3522 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3523 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3524 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3525 in the target config file.
3526 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3527 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3528 config file instead.
3529 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3530 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3531 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3532
3533 @example
3534 jtag_rclk 3000
3535 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3536 @end example
3537
3538 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3539 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3540 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3541 may not be the fastest solution.
3542
3543 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3544 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3545 which support adaptive clocking.
3546
3547 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3548 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3549 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3550 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3551 than the speed specified.
3552
3553 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3554 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3555 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3556 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3557
3558 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3559 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3560 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3561 JTAG clocking after setup.
3562 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3563 If the interface device can not
3564 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3565 @end deffn
3566
3567 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3568 @cindex adaptive clocking
3569 @cindex RTCK
3570 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3571 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3572 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3573 @example
3574 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3575 jtag_rclk 3000
3576 @end example
3577 @end defun
3578
3579 @node Reset Configuration
3580 @chapter Reset Configuration
3581 @cindex Reset Configuration
3582
3583 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3584 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3585 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3586 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3587 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3588 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3589 Please see the various board files for examples.
3590
3591 @quotation Note
3592 To maintainers and integrators:
3593 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3594 Normally the board configuration file
3595 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3596 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3597
3598 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3599 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3600 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3601 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3602 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3603 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3604 @end quotation
3605
3606 @section Types of Reset
3607
3608 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3609 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3610 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3611
3612 @itemize @bullet
3613 @item
3614 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3615 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3616 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3617 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3618 @item
3619 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3620 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3621 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3622 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3623 @item
3624 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3625 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3626 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3627 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3628 @item
3629 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3630 several other types of reset.
3631 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3632 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3633 There may be individual module resets.
3634 @end itemize
3635
3636 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3637 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3638 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3639 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3640 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3641 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3642 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3643 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3644 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3645
3646 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3647 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3648
3649 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3650 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3651 common issues are:
3652
3653 @itemize @bullet
3654
3655 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3656 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3657 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3658 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3659 when either of those signals is not connected.
3660 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3661 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3662 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3663 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3664
3665 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3666 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3667 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3668 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3669
3670 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3671 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3672 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3673 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3674 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3675 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3676 hardware debouncing.
3677 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3678 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3679
3680 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3681 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3682 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3683 to use push/pull output drivers.
3684 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3685 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3686 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3687 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3688
3689 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3690 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3691 issues (not limited to errata).
3692 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3693 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3694 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3695 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3696 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3697 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3698 @end itemize
3699
3700 There can also be other issues.
3701 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3702 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3703 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3704 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3705 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3706 Agreement (NDA).
3707
3708 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3709 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3710 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3711
3712 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3713 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3714
3715 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3716
3717 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3718 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3719 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3720 allowing it to be deasserted.
3721 @end deffn
3722
3723 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3724 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3725 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3726 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3727 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3728 @end deffn
3729
3730 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3731 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3732 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3733 allowing it to be deasserted.
3734 @end deffn
3735
3736 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3737 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3738 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3739 @end deffn
3740
3741 @anchor{reset_config}
3742 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3743 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3744 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3745 configuration scripts.
3746
3747 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3748 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3749 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3750 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3751 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3752 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3753 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3754 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3755
3756 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3757 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3758 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3759 -- may be specified at a time.
3760 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3761 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3762 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3763 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3764 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3765
3766 @itemize
3767 @item
3768 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3769 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3770 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3771 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3772 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3773
3774 @quotation Tip
3775 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3776 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3777 @end quotation
3778
3779 @item
3780 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3781 signal implementations.
3782 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3783 indicating everything behaves normally.
3784 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3785 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3786 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3787 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3788 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3789 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3790 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3791
3792 @item
3793 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3794 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3795 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3796 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3797 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3798 while SRST is asserted.
3799 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3800 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3801
3802 @item
3803 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3804 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3805 is required to use this option.
3806 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3807 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3808 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3809 be asserted before any target connection.
3810 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3811 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3812 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3813 @end itemize
3814
3815 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3816 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3817 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3818 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3819 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3820
3821 @itemize
3822 @item
3823 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3824 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3825 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3826 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3827
3828 @item
3829 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3830 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3831 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3832 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3833 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3834 @end itemize
3835 @end deffn
3836
3837 @section Custom Reset Handling
3838 @cindex events
3839
3840 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3841 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3842 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3843 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3844 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3845 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3846
3847 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3848 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3849 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3850 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3851 want to reset everything at once.
3852
3853 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3854 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3855 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3856 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3857 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3858 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3859 needs special attention.
3860
3861 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3862 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3863 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3864 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3865 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3866 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3867 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3868 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3869 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3870
3871 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3872 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3873 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3874 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3875 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3876
3877 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3878 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3879 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3880 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3881 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3882 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3883 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3884 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3885 or potentially some other value.
3886
3887 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3888 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3889 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3890 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3891 (or their associated targets)
3892 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3893
3894 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3895 they return.
3896 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3897 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3898 @end deffn
3899
3900 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3901 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3902 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3903 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3904 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3905 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3906 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3907 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3908 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3909 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3910 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3911 @end deffn
3912
3913 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3914 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3915 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3916 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3917 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3918 @end deffn
3919
3920
3921 @node TAP Declaration
3922 @chapter TAP Declaration
3923 @cindex TAP declaration
3924 @cindex TAP configuration
3925
3926 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3927 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3928
3929 @itemize @bullet
3930 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3931 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3932 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3933 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3934 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3935 start running that code.
3936 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3937 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3938 and missing connections.
3939 @end itemize
3940
3941 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3942 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3943 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3944 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3945 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3946
3947 @section Scan Chains
3948 @cindex scan chain
3949
3950 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3951 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3952 They also need to be added to
3953 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3954 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3955 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3956 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3957 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3958 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3959 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3960 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3961
3962 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3963 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3964 command, presented in the next chapter.
3965 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3966 debugging targets.)
3967 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3968
3969 @verbatim
3970 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3971 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3972 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3973 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3974 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3975 @end verbatim
3976
3977 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3978 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3979 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3980 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3981 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3982 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3983 until they are told to do so.
3984
3985 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3986 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3987 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3988 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3989
3990 @example
3991 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3992 @end example
3993
3994 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3995 by a given chip.
3996 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3997 and so forth.
3998 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3999 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4000 both inside a single chip and between them.
4001 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4002
4003 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4004 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4005 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4006 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4007 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4008 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4009 includes commands something like this:
4010
4011 @example
4012 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4013 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4014 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4015 @end example
4016
4017 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4018 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4019 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4020
4021 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4022 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4023 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4024 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4025 @example
4026 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4027 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4028 @}
4029 @end example
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4033 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4034 and their status.
4035 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4036 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4037 but systems with a JTAG router can
4038 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4039 @end deffn
4040
4041 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4042 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4043
4044 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4045 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4046
4047 @section TAP Names
4048 @cindex dotted name
4049
4050 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4051 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4052 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4053 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4054 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4055 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4056 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4057 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4058
4059 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4060 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4061 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4062
4063 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4064
4065 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4066 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4067 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4068
4069 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4070 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4071 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4072 overridable.
4073
4074 @cindex TAP naming convention
4075 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4076 and should follow this convention:
4077
4078 @itemize @bullet
4079 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4080 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4081 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4082 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4083 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4084 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4085 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4086 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4087 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4088 with a single TAP;
4089 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4090 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4091 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4092 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4093 @end itemize
4094
4095 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4096
4097 @itemize @bullet
4098 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4099 @*The length in bits of the
4100 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4101 @end itemize
4102
4103 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4104
4105 @itemize @bullet
4106 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4107 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4108 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4109 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4110 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4111 (the TAP is linked in).
4112 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4113 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4114 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4115 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4116 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4117 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4118 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4119 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4120 values that were found but not included in the list.
4121
4122 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4123 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4124 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4125 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4126 hardware to find these values.
4127 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4128 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4129 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4130 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4131 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4132 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4133 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4134 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4135 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4136 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4137 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4138 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4139 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4140 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4141 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4142 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4143 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4144 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4145 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4146 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4147 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4148 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4149 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4150 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4151 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4152 @end itemize
4153 @end deffn
4154
4155 @section Other TAP commands
4156
4157 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4158 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4159 @end deffn
4160
4161 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4162 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4163 At this writing this TAP attribute
4164 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4165 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4166 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4167 See the next section for information about the available events.
4168
4169 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4170 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4171 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @section TAP Events
4175 @cindex events
4176 @cindex TAP events
4177
4178 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4179 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4180 The other applies to debugger targets,
4181 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4182
4183 The TAP events currently defined are:
4184
4185 @itemize @bullet
4186 @item @b{post-reset}
4187 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4188 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4189 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4190 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4191 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4192
4193 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4194 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4195 of any particular target.
4196 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4197 @item @b{setup}
4198 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4199 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4200 @item @b{tap-disable}
4201 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4202 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4203 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4204 @item @b{tap-enable}
4205 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4206 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4207 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4208 @end itemize
4209
4210 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4211 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4212 contents to be accurate), you might:
4213
4214 @example
4215 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4216 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4217 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4218 @}
4219 @end example
4220
4221
4222 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4223 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4224 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4225 @cindex jrc
4226
4227 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4228 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4229 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4230 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4231 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4232
4233 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4234 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4235 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4236 be visible.
4237 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4238 ignores, such as:
4239
4240 @itemize
4241 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4242 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4243 TAPs receive new instructions.
4244 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4245 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4246 @end itemize
4247
4248 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4249 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4250 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4251 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4252
4253 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4254 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4255
4256 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4257 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4258 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4259 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4260 should define TAP event handlers using
4261 code that looks something like this:
4262
4263 @example
4264 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4265 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4266 @}
4267 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4268 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4269 @}
4270 @end example
4271
4272 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4273
4274 @example
4275 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4276 @end example
4277
4278 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4279 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4280 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4281 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4282
4283 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4284 If necessary, disables the tap
4285 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4286 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4287 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4288 and "0" if it is disabled.
4289 @end deffn
4290
4291 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4292 If necessary, enables the tap
4293 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4294 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4295 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4296 and "0" if it is disabled.
4297 @end deffn
4298
4299 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4300 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4301 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4302 and "0" if it is disabled.
4303
4304 @quotation Note
4305 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4306 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4307 @end quotation
4308 @end deffn
4309
4310 @anchor{autoprobing}
4311 @section Autoprobing
4312 @cindex autoprobe
4313 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4314
4315 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4316 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4317 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4318 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4319
4320 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4321 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4322 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4323 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4324 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4325 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4326 right when they come out of reset).
4327
4328 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4329
4330 @example
4331 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4332 reset_config trst_and_srst
4333 jtag_rclk 8
4334 @end example
4335
4336 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4337 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4338
4339 @enumerate
4340 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4341 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4342 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4343 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4344 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4345 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4346 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4347 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4348 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4349 that is discovered.
4350 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4351 register, it will report it.
4352 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4353 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4354 @end enumerate
4355
4356 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4357 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4358 that's a bit more complex:
4359
4360 @example
4361 clock speed 8 kHz
4362 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4363 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4364 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4365 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4366 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4367 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4368 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4369 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4370 @end example
4371
4372 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4373 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4374 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4375 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4376 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4377 and so forth.
4378
4379 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4380 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4381 @cindex DAP declaration
4382
4383 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4384 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4385 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4386 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4387 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4388
4389 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4390
4391 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4392 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4393 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4394 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4395 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4396
4397 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4398
4399 @itemize @bullet
4400 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4401 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4402 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4403 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4404 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4405 @end itemize
4406 @end deffn
4407
4408 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4409 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4410 for TCL scripting.
4411 @end deffn
4412
4413 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4414 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4415 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4416 @end deffn
4417
4418 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4419 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4420 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4421 initialization, too.
4422 @end deffn
4423
4424 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4425
4426 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4427 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4428 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4429 @end deffn
4430
4431 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4432 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4433 @end deffn
4434
4435 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4436 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4437 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4438 or set a new value @var{value}.
4439 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4440 @end deffn
4441
4442 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4443 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4444 @end deffn
4445
4446 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4447 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4448 value @var{value}.
4449
4450 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4451 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4452 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4453
4454 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4455 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4456 @end deffn
4457
4458 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4459 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4460 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4461 @end deffn
4462
4463 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4464 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4465 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4466 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4467 @end deffn
4468
4469 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4470 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4471
4472 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4473 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4474 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4475 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4476 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4477 for details.
4478
4479 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4480 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4481 the pattern:
4482 @example
4483 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4484 @end example
4485
4486 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4487 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4488 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4489 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4490 @example
4491 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4492 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4493 @end example
4494
4495 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4496 @example
4497 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4498 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4499 @end example
4500
4501 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4502 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4503
4504 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4505 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4506 example with a proper dap name:
4507 @example
4508 xxx.dap apcsw default
4509 @end example
4510 @end deffn
4511
4512 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4513 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4514 Disabled by default
4515 @end deffn
4516
4517
4518 @node CPU Configuration
4519 @chapter CPU Configuration
4520 @cindex GDB target
4521
4522 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4523 You can also access these targets without GDB
4524 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4525 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4526 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4527 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4528
4529 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4530 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4531
4532 @section Target List
4533 @cindex target, current
4534 @cindex target, list
4535
4536 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4537 where each member has a name.
4538 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4539 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4540 (plural!) command.
4541 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4542 look like with more than one:
4543 @verbatim
4544 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4545 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4546 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4547 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4548 @end verbatim
4549
4550 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4551 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4552 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4553 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4554 space seen by that current target.
4555 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4556 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4557 are examples; and there are many more.
4558
4559 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4560
4561 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4562 Returns the name of the current target.
4563 @end deffn
4564
4565 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4566 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4567 @example
4568 foreach t [target names] @{
4569 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4570 @}
4571 @end example
4572 @end deffn
4573
4574 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4575 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4576
4577 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4578 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4579 command names are singular.}
4580
4581 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4582 targets in a user friendly form.
4583
4584 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4585 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4586 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4587 @end deffn
4588
4589 @section Target CPU Types
4590 @cindex target type
4591 @cindex CPU type
4592
4593 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4594 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4595 when calling @command{target create}.
4596 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4597 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4598 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4599 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4600 what core-specific commands may be available
4601 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4602 and more.
4603
4604 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4605 since there's a command to list them.
4606
4607 @anchor{targettypes}
4608 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4609 Lists all supported target types.
4610 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4611
4612 @itemize @bullet
4613 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4614 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4615 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4616 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4617 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4618 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4619 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4620 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4621 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4622 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4623 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4624 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4625 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4626 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4627 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4628 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4629 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4630 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4631 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4632 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4633 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4634 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4635 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4636 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4637 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4638 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4639 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4640 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4641 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4642 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4643 support for new CPUs.
4644 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4645 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4646 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4647 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4648 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4649 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4650 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4651 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4652 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4653 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4654 @itemize @minus
4655 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4656 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4657 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4658 @end itemize
4659 And two debug interfaces cores:
4660 @itemize @minus
4661 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4662 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4663 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4664 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4665 @end itemize
4666 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4667 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4668 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4669 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4670 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4671 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4672 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4673 @end itemize
4674 @end deffn
4675
4676 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4677 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4678 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4679 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4680 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4681 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4682 reflect design generations;
4683 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4684 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4685
4686 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4687 @section Target Configuration
4688
4689 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4690 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4691 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4692 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4693 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4694
4695 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4696 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4697 optional parts.
4698 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4699 command, created as part of target creation.
4700
4701 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4702 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4703 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4704 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4705 to be much more board-specific.
4706 The key steps you use might look something like this
4707
4708 @example
4709 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4710 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4711 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4712 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4713 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4714 @end example
4715
4716 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4717 on-chip SRAM.
4718 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4719 writes to target memory;
4720 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4721 GDB memory checksumming;
4722 and more.
4723
4724 @quotation Warning
4725 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4726 inaccessible when application code
4727 (such as an operating system)
4728 enables or disables the MMU.
4729 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4730 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4731 easy access to other addresses needed.
4732 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4733 @end quotation
4734
4735 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4736 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4737 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4738 controllers.
4739 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4740 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4741 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4742
4743 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4744 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4745 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4746 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4747 purposes including additional configuration.
4748
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4751 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4752 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4753 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4754
4755 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4756 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4757 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4758 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4759 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4760 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4761 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4762
4763 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4764 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4765 @end itemize
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4769 The options accepted by this command may also be
4770 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4771 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4772 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4773
4774 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4775 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4776 and changing its endianness.
4777
4778 @itemize @bullet
4779
4780 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4781 used to access this target.
4782
4783 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4784 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4785 create and manage DAP instances.
4786
4787 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4788 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4789
4790 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4791 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4792 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4793 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4794 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4795 same event name assigns only one handler.
4796
4797 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4798 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4799
4800 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4801 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4802 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4803 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4804 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4805 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4806 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4807
4808 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4809 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4810 or virtual address is being used.
4811
4812 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4813 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4814
4815 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4816 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4817 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4818 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4819 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4820
4821 @anchor{rtostype}
4822 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4823 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4824 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4825 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4826 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4827 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4828
4829 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4830 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4831 access the target for debugging.
4832
4833 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4834 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4835 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4836 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4837
4838 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4839 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4840 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4841 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4842 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4843
4844 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4845 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4846 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4847 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4848 command @command{gdb_port}.
4849 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4850
4851 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4852 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4853 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4854 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4855 @end itemize
4856 @end deffn
4857
4858 @section Other $target_name Commands
4859 @cindex object command
4860
4861 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4862 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4863
4864 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4865 Once a button is created a button
4866 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4867 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4868 configure it like this:
4869
4870 @example
4871 # Create
4872 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4873 # Modify
4874 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4875 # Query
4876 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4877 # Report
4878 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4879 @end example
4880
4881 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4882 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4883
4884 @example
4885 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4886 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4887 @end example
4888
4889 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4890
4891 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4892 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4893 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4894 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4895 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4896 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4897 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4898 They are not otherwise documented here.
4899 @end deffn
4900
4901 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4902 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4903 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4904 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4905 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4906 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4907 the target side uses raw memory.
4908
4909 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4910 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4911 The script orientation comes from working with data
4912 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4913 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4914 and neither store nor return those values.
4915
4916 @itemize
4917 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4918 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4919 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4920 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4921 @end itemize
4922 @end deffn
4923
4924 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4925 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4926 @command{$target_name configure}
4927 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4928 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4929 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4930 There are a few special cases:
4931
4932 @itemize @bullet
4933 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4934 event named @var{event_name}.
4935 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4936 two parameters.
4937 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4938 This is a special case because this is set using
4939 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4940 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4941 @end itemize
4942
4943 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4944 all the targets you might use something like this:
4945
4946 @example
4947 foreach name [target names] @{
4948 set y [$name cget -endian]
4949 set z [$name cget -type]
4950 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4951 $x $name $y $z]
4952 @}
4953 @end example
4954 @end deffn
4955
4956 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4957 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4958 Displays the current target state:
4959 @code{debug-running},
4960 @code{halted},
4961 @code{reset},
4962 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4963 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4964 @end deffn
4965
4966 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4967 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4968 currently associated with this target.
4969 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4970 @end deffn
4971
4972 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4973 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4974 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4975 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4976 @end deffn
4977
4978 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4979 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4980 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4981 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4982 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4983 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4984 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4985 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4986 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4987 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4988 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4989 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4990 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4991 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4992 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4993 @end deffn
4994
4995 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4996 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4997 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4998 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4999 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5000 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5001 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5002 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5003 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5004 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5005 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5006 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5007 @end deffn
5008
5009 @anchor{targetevents}
5010 @section Target Events
5011 @cindex target events
5012 @cindex events
5013 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5014 For example:
5015 @itemize @bullet
5016 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5017 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5018 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5019 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5020 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5021 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5022 to set up system clocks or
5023 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5024 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5025 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5026 @end itemize
5027
5028 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5029 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5030 @command{target create ... -event}.
5031
5032 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5033 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5034 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5035
5036 @example
5037 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5038 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5039 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5040 @}
5041 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5042 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5043 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5044 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5045 @}
5046 @end example
5047
5048 The following target events are defined:
5049
5050 @itemize @bullet
5051 @item @b{debug-halted}
5052 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5053 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5054 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5055 @item @b{early-halted}
5056 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5057 @item @b{examine-start}
5058 @* Before target examine is called.
5059 @item @b{examine-end}
5060 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5061 @item @b{examine-fail}
5062 @* After target examine fails.
5063 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5064 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5065 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5066 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5067 connect GDB to running target.
5068 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5069 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5070 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5071 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5072 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5073 is in RAM or read only memory.
5074 Default is @code{halt}
5075 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5076 @* When GDB disconnects
5077 @item @b{gdb-end}
5078 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5079 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5080 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5081 @code{reset init})
5082 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5083 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5084 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5085 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5086 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5087 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5088 @item @b{gdb-start}
5089 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5090 @item @b{halted}
5091 @* The target has halted
5092 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5093 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5094 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5095 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5096 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5097 @item @b{reset-assert}
5098 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5099 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5100 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5101 it instead of asserting SRST.
5102 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5103 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5104 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5105 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5106 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5107 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5108 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5109 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5110 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5111 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5112 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5113 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5114 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5115 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5116 released on the scan chain.
5117 @item @b{reset-end}
5118 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5119 @item @b{reset-init}
5120 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5121 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5122
5123 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5124 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5125 multiplexing, and so on.
5126 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5127 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5128 @item @b{reset-start}
5129 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5130 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5131
5132 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5133 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5134 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5135 @item @b{resume-start}
5136 @* Before any target is resumed
5137 @item @b{resume-end}
5138 @* After all targets have resumed
5139 @item @b{resumed}
5140 @* Target has resumed
5141 @item @b{step-start}
5142 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5143 @item @b{step-end}
5144 @* After single-step has completed
5145 @item @b{trace-config}
5146 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5147 @end itemize
5148
5149 @quotation Note
5150 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5151 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5152 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5153 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5154 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5155 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5156 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5157 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5158 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5159 check if the core has changed status.
5160 @end quotation
5161
5162 @node Flash Commands
5163 @chapter Flash Commands
5164
5165 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5166 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5167 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5168 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5169 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5170 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5171 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5172 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5173 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5174
5175 Flash Steps:
5176 @enumerate
5177 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5178 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5179 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5180 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5181 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5182 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5183 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5184 @item GDB Flashing
5185 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5186 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5187 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5188 @end enumerate
5189
5190 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5191 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5192 so that it can't boot.
5193 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5194 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5195
5196 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5197 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5198 @cindex flash configuration
5199
5200 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5201 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5202 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5203 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5204 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5205 see the driver-specific documentation.
5206
5207 @itemize @bullet
5208 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5209 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5210 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5211 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5212 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5213 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5214 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5215 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5216 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5217 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5218 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5219 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5220 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5221 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5222 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5223 commands to the flash controller.
5224 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5225 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5226 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5227 for more information.
5228 @end itemize
5229 @quotation Note
5230 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5231 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5232 @end quotation
5233 @end deffn
5234
5235 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5236 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5237 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5238 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5239 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5240 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5241 @end deffn
5242
5243 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5244 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5245 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5246 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5247 @end deffn
5248
5249 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5250 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5251 depends on the flash type.
5252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5253 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5254 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5255 but most don't bother.
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5259
5260 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5261 begins.
5262
5263 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5264 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5265 until the programming session is finished.
5266
5267 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5268 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5269
5270 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5271
5272 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5273 @cindex flash erasing
5274 @cindex flash reading
5275 @cindex flash writing
5276 @cindex flash programming
5277 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5278
5279 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5280 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5281 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5282 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5283 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5284
5285 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5286 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5287 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5288 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5289 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5290
5291 @quotation Note
5292 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5293 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5294 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5295 back to a flash bank.
5296 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5297 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5298 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5299 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5300 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5301 @end quotation
5302
5303 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5304 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5305 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5306 disabled first.
5307 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5308 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5309 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5310
5311 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5312 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5313 up to and including @var{last}.
5314 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5315 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5316 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5317 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5318 @end deffn
5319
5320 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5321 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5322 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5323 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5324 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5325 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5326 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5327 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5328 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5329 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5330 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5331 before erase starts.
5332 @end deffn
5333
5334 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5335 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5336 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5337 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5338 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5339 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5340 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5341 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5342 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5343 before issuing this command.
5344 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5345 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5346 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5347 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5348 @end deffn
5349 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5350
5351 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5352 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5353 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5354 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5355 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5356 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5357 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5358 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5359 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5360 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5361 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5362 @end deffn
5363
5364 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5365 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5366 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5367 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5368 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5369 @end deffn
5370
5371 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5372 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5373 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5374 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5375 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5376 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5380 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5381 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5382 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5383 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5384 @end deffn
5385
5386 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5387 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5388 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5389 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5390 to the base address for each section in the image.
5391 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5392 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5393 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5394 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5395 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5396 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5397 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5398 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5399 each image section.
5400
5401 @quotation Warning
5402 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5403 data you want to preserve.
5404 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5405 sections might be erased with no notice.
5406 @itemize
5407 @item
5408 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5409 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5410 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5411 @item
5412 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5413 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5414 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5415 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5416 @end itemize
5417 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5418 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5419 @end quotation
5420
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5424 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5425 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5426 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5427 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5428 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5429 ordinary memory reads.
5430 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5431 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5432 check for successful programming.
5433 @end deffn
5434
5435 @section Other Flash commands
5436 @cindex flash protection
5437
5438 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5439 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5440 and display that status.
5441 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5442 @end deffn
5443
5444 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5445 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5446 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5447
5448 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5449 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5450 and possibly stale information.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @anchor{flashprotect}
5454 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5455 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5456 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5457 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5458 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5459 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5461 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5462 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5463 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5464 @end deffn
5465
5466 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5467 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5468 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5469 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5470 @end deffn
5471
5472 @anchor{program}
5473 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5474 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5475 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5476 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5477 @end deffn
5478
5479 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5480 @section Flash Driver List
5481 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5482 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5483 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5484
5485 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5486 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5487 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5488
5489 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5490
5491 @itemize
5492 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5493 @end itemize
5494
5495 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5496 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5497 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5498 @example
5499 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5500 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5501 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5502 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5503 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5504 @end example
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @subsection External Flash
5508
5509 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5510 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5511 @cindex CFI
5512 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5513 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5514 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5515 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5516 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5517 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5518 configure a bus and its timings), or
5519 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5520 on the flash chip.
5521 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5522 speed up operation.
5523
5524 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5525
5526 @itemize
5527 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5528 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5529 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5530 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5531 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5532 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5533 @end itemize
5534
5535 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5536 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5537
5538 @example
5539 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5540 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5541 @end example
5542
5543 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5544 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5545 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5546
5547 @example
5548 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5549 @end example
5550
5551 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5552 @end deffn
5553
5554 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5555 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5556 @cindex SPI
5557 @cindex jtagspi
5558 @cindex bscan_spi
5559 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5560 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5561 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5562 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5563 accessed through JTAG.
5564
5565 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5566 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5567 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5568 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5569 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5570 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5571
5572 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5573 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5574 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5575 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5576 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5577 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5578 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5579 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5580
5581 @itemize
5582 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5583 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5584 @var{USER1} instruction.
5585 @end itemize
5586
5587 @example
5588 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5589 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5590 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5591 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5592 @end example
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5596 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5597 @cindex xcf
5598 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5599 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5600 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5601 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5602 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5603
5604 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5605 command accepts additional parameters:
5606 @itemize
5607 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5608 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5609 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5610 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5611 in master mode.
5612 @end itemize
5613 @example
5614 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5615 @end example
5616 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5617 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5618 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5619 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5620 dedicated sector.
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5624 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5625 button.
5626 @example
5627 xcf configure 0
5628 @end example
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 Additional driver notes:
5632 @itemize
5633 @item Only single revision supported.
5634 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5635 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5636 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5637 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5638 @end itemize
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5642 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5643 @cindex SPIFI
5644 @cindex lpcspifi
5645 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5646 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5647 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5648
5649 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5650 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5651 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5652 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5653 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5654
5655 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5656 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5657 are configured by the driver.
5658
5659 @example
5660 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5661 @end example
5662
5663 @end deffn
5664
5665 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5666 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5667 @cindex SMI
5668 @cindex stmsmi
5669 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5670 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5671 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5672 SPI flash devices.
5673 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5674 flash devices can be connected.
5675
5676 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5677 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5678 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5679 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5680 the flash content.
5681
5682 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5683 to identify the memory bank.
5684 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5685 flash size, are detected automatically.
5686
5687 @example
5688 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5689 @end example
5690
5691 @end deffn
5692
5693 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5694 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5695 @cindex QuadSPI
5696 @cindex OctoSPI
5697 @cindex stmqspi
5698 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5699 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5700 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5701 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5702 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5703 mode is not.
5704
5705 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5706 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5707 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5708 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5709
5710 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5711 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5712 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5713
5714 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5715 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5716 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5717 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5718 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5719 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5720
5721 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5722 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5723 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5724 should be avoided.
5725
5726 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5727 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5728 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5729 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5730 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5731 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5732
5733 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5734 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5735 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5736 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5737 persist across openocd invocations.
5738
5739 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5740 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5741 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5742 required (see 'set' command).
5743
5744 @example
5745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5746 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5748 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5749 @end example
5750
5751 There are three specific commands
5752 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5753 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5754 chip specific write protection engaged.
5755 @end deffn
5756
5757 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5758 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5759 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5760 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5761 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5762 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5763
5764 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5765 which don't support an id command.
5766
5767 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5768 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5769 @end deffn
5770
5771 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5772 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5773 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5774 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5775 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5776
5777 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5778 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5779 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5780 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5781
5782 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5783
5784 To check basic communication settings, issue
5785 @example
5786 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5787 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5788 @end example
5789 for single flash mode or
5790 @example
5791 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5792 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5793 @end example
5794 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5795
5796 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5797 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5798 need a dummy address, e.g.
5799 @example
5800 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5801 @end example
5802 should return the status register contents.
5803
5804 @end deffn
5805
5806 @end deffn
5807
5808 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5809 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5810 Microcontroller platform.
5811
5812 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5813 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5814
5815 @example
5816 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5817 @end example
5818
5819 @end deffn
5820
5821 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5822 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5823 @cindex ath79
5824 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5825 chip selects.
5826 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5827 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5828 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5829 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5830 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5831 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5832
5833 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5834 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5835 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5836 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5837 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5838 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5839 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5840 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5841 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5842 with the default CS0.
5843 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5844 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5845 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5846
5847 @example
5848 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5849
5850 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5851 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5852 # distinguish the banks.
5853 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5854 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5855 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5856 @end example
5857
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5861 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5862 @cindex fespi
5863
5864 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5865
5866 @example
5867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5868 @end example
5869 @end deffn
5870
5871 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5872
5873 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5874 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5875 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5876 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5877 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5878 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5879
5880 @example
5881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5882 @end example
5883 @end deffn
5884
5885 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5886 @cindex ambiqmicro
5887 @cindex apollo
5888 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5889 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5890 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5891 with the target using SWD.
5892
5893 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5894 the device class of the MCU.
5895 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5896 to set up the flash banks.
5897 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5898 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5899
5900 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5901 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5902 and the second bank starts after the first.
5903
5904 @example
5905 # Flash bank 0
5906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5907 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5909 $_TARGETNAME
5910 @end example
5911
5912 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5913 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5914 are available to the user.
5915
5916 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5917
5918 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5919 Erase entire bank.
5920 @end deffn
5921 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5922 Erase device pages.
5923 @end deffn
5924 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5925 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5926 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5927 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5928 the flash.
5929 @end deffn
5930 @end deffn
5931
5932 @anchor{at91samd}
5933 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5934 @cindex at91samd
5935 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5936 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5937
5938 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5939
5940 The devices have one flash bank:
5941
5942 @example
5943 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5944 @end example
5945
5946 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5947 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5948 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5949 processor to be halted.
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5953 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5954 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5955 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5956 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5957 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5958
5959 @example
5960 at91samd set-security enable
5961 @end example
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5965 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5966 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5967 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5968 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5969 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5970 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5971 in order to disable this feature.
5972
5973 @example
5974 at91samd eeprom
5975 at91samd eeprom 1024
5976 @end example
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5980 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5981 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5982 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5983 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5984 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5985
5986 @example
5987 at91samd bootloader
5988 at91samd bootloader 16384
5989 @end example
5990 @end deffn
5991
5992 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5993 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5994 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5995 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5996 @end deffn
5997
5998 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5999 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6000 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6001 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6002 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6003 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6004 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6005 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6006
6007 @example
6008 # Read user row
6009 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6010 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6011 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6012 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6013 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6014 # byte unchanged
6015 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6016 @end example
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @end deffn
6020
6021 @anchor{at91sam3}
6022 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6023 @cindex at91sam3
6024 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6025 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6026 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6027 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6028 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6029 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6030 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6031 chips are confirmed.}
6032
6033 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6034 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6035 the following fixed locations:
6036
6037 @example
6038 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6039 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6040 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6041 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6042 @end example
6043
6044 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6045 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6046 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6047
6048 @itemize
6049 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6050 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6051 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6052 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6053 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6054 @end itemize
6055
6056 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6057
6058 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6059 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6060 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6061 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6062 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6063 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6064 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6065
6066 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6067 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6071 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6072 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6073 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6074 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6075 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6076 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6077 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6078 @end deffn
6079
6080 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6081 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6082 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6083 @end deffn
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6087 @cindex at91sam4
6088 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6089 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6090 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6091 @end deffn
6092
6093 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6094 @cindex at91sam4l
6095 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6096 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6097 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6098
6099 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6100 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6101 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6102 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6103 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6104 @end deffn
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @anchor{atsame5}
6108 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6109 @cindex atsame5
6110 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6111 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6112 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6113
6114 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6115 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6116 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6117
6118 @example
6119 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6120 @end example
6121
6122 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6123 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6124 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6125 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6126 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6127 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6128
6129 @example
6130 atsame5 bootloader
6131 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6132 @end example
6133 @end deffn
6134
6135 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6136 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6137 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6138 processor to be halted.
6139 @end deffn
6140
6141 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6142 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6143 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6144 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6145 @end deffn
6146
6147 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6148 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6149 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6150 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6151 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6152 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6153 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6154 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6155
6156 @example
6157 # Read
6158 >atsame5 userpage
6159 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6160 # Write
6161 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6162 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6163 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6164 # bytes)
6165 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6166 @end example
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @end deffn
6170
6171 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6172 @cindex atsamv
6173 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6174 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6175 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6179 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6180 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6181 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6182 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6183
6184 @example
6185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6186 @end example
6187
6188 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6189 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6190
6191 @itemize
6192 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6193 @item @var{banks}
6194 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6195 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6196 @item @var{pages_size}
6197 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6198 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6199 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6200 @end itemize
6201
6202 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6203 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6204 will be autoconfigured.
6205 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6206
6207 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6208 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6209 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6210 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6211 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6212
6213 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6214 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6215 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6216 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6217 are not truly general purpose).
6218 @quotation Note
6219 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6220 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6221 @end quotation
6222 @end deffn
6223 @end deffn
6224
6225 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6226 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6227 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6228 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6232 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6233 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6234 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6235
6236 @example
6237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6238 @end example
6239
6240 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6241 each single sector one by one.
6242
6243 @example
6244 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6245 @end example
6246
6247 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6251 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6252 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6253 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6254 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6255 starts at address 0.
6256
6257 @example
6258 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6259 @end example
6260 @end deffn
6261
6262 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6263 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6264 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6265 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6266 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6267 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6268 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6269 and programming the serial flash.
6270
6271 @example
6272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6273 @end example
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6277 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6278 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6279 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6280 autoconfigures itself.
6281 @example
6282 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6283 @end example
6284 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6285 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6286 this via the following command:
6287 @example
6288 efm32 debuglock num
6289 @end example
6290 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6291 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6292 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6293 supported.}
6294 @end deffn
6295
6296 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6297 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6298 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6299 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6300 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6301 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6302
6303 @example
6304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6305 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6306 @end example
6307
6308 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6309 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6313 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6314 is an uncommon operation.}
6315 @end deffn
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6319 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6320 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6321 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6322 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6323 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6324 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6325
6326 @example
6327 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6328 @end example
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6332 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6333 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6334 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6335 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6336 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6337 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6338 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6339 characters) ignored.
6340
6341 @example
6342 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6343 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6344 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6345 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6346 @end example
6347 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6348 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6349 @end deffn
6350
6351 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6352 @cindex kinetis
6353 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6354 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6355 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6356 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6357 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6358 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6359
6360 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6361 @itemize
6362 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6363 @end itemize
6364
6365 @example
6366 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6367 @end example
6368
6369 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6370 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6371 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6372 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6373 @end deffn
6374
6375 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6376 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6377 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6378 set by 'flash protect' command.
6379 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6380 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6381 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6382 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6383 with the rest of a flash image.
6384 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6385 @end deffn
6386
6387 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6388 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6389 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6393 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6394 and examine-fail event.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6398 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6399 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6400 @end deffn
6401
6402 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6403 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6404 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6405 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6406 command completes.
6407 @end deffn
6408
6409 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6410 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6411 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6412 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6413 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6414
6415 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6416 Program Partition command.
6417
6418 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6419 Reset the device after partition setting.
6420
6421 Show partition size:
6422 @example
6423 kinetis nvm_partition info
6424 @end example
6425
6426 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6427 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6428 @example
6429 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6430 @end example
6431
6432 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6433 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6434 @example
6435 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6436 @end example
6437 @end deffn
6438
6439 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6440 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6441 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6442 @end deffn
6443
6444 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6445 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6446 Command disables watchdog timer.
6447 @end deffn
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6451 @cindex kinetis_ke
6452 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6453 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6454 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6455 autoconfigures itself.
6456 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6457
6458 @example
6459 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6460 @end example
6461
6462 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6463 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6467 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6468 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6469 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6470 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6471 @end deffn
6472
6473 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6474 Command disables watchdog timer.
6475 @end deffn
6476 @end deffn
6477
6478 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6479 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6480 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6481 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6482 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6483
6484 @quotation Note
6485 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6486 driver:
6487 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6488 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6489 @end quotation
6490
6491 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6492 which must appear in the following order:
6493
6494 @itemize
6495 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6496 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6497 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6498 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6499 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6500 LPC43x[2357])
6501 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6502 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6503 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6504 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6505 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6506 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6507 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6508 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6509 at which the core is running
6510 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6511 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6512 @quotation Note
6513 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6514 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6515 However, if you do provide it,
6516 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6517 @end quotation
6518 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6519 ROM IAP entry point.
6520 @end itemize
6521
6522 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6523
6524 @example
6525 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6526 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6527 @end example
6528
6529 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6530 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6531 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6532 @end deffn
6533 @end deffn
6534
6535 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6536 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6537 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6538 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6539 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6540 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6541
6542 @example
6543 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6544 @end example
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6548 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6549 from NXP.
6550
6551 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6552 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6553 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6554 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6555 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6556 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6557 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6558 you start the PLL.
6559
6560 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6561
6562 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6563 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6564 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6565
6566 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6567 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6568 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6569 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6570 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6571 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6572 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6573
6574 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6575 @example
6576 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6577 @end example
6578
6579 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6580 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6581 @code{flash banks} command.
6582
6583 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6584 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6585 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6586 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6587 a known signature.
6588 Example:
6589 @example
6590 lpc2900 signature 0
6591 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6592 @end example
6593 @end deffn
6594
6595 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6596 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6597 saves it to a file in binary format.
6598 Example:
6599 @example
6600 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6601 @end example
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6605 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6606 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6607 command:
6608
6609 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6610 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6611 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6612 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6613
6614 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6615 Example:
6616 @example
6617 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6618 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6619 @end example
6620 @end deffn
6621
6622 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6623 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6624 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6625 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6626 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6627 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6628 912 bytes.
6629 @quotation Attention
6630 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6631 @end quotation
6632 Example:
6633 @example
6634 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6635 @end example
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6639 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6640 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6641 after the next power cycle.
6642 @quotation Attention
6643 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6644 @end quotation
6645 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6646 Example:
6647 @example
6648 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6649 flash info 0
6650 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6651 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6652 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6653 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6654 @end example
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6658 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6659 effective after the next power cycle.
6660 @quotation Attention
6661 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6662 @end quotation
6663 Examples:
6664 @example
6665 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6666 @end example
6667 @end deffn
6668 @end deffn
6669
6670 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6671 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6672 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6673 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6674
6675 @example
6676 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6677 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6678 @end example
6679
6680 @itemize @bullet
6681 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6682 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6683 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6684 @end itemize
6685
6686 Example usage:
6687 @example
6688 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6689 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6690 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6691 @} else @{
6692 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6693 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6694 @}
6695 @end example
6696 @end deffn
6697
6698 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6699 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6700 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6701 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6702 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6703 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6704
6705 @example
6706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6707 @end example
6708
6709 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6710 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6711 only the main program flash.
6712
6713 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6714 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6715 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6719 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6720 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6721 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6722
6723 To erase and program the BSL:
6724 @example
6725 msp432 bsl unlock
6726 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6727 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6728 msp432 bsl lock
6729 @end example
6730 @end deffn
6731 @end deffn
6732
6733 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6734 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6735 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6736 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6737 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6738 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6739 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6740 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6741 also have division into regions: main and info.
6742 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6743 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6744
6745 @example
6746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6747 @end example
6748
6749 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6750
6751 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6752 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6756 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6757 @end deffn
6758
6759 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6760 Erase all userflash including info region.
6761 @end deffn
6762
6763 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6764 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6768 Check sectors protect.
6769 @end deffn
6770
6771 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6772 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6773 @end deffn
6774
6775 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6776 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6780 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6784 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6788 Show information about flash driver.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @end deffn
6792
6793 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6794 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6795 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6796 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6797 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6798
6799 @example
6800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6801 @end example
6802 @end deffn
6803
6804 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6805 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6806 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6807 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6808 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6809
6810 @example
6811 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6812 @end example
6813
6814 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6815
6816 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6817 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6818 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6819 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6820 code.
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6824 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6830 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6831 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6832
6833 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6834 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6835 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6836 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6837
6838 @example
6839 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6840 @end example
6841 @end deffn
6842
6843 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6844 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6845 and integrate flash memory.
6846
6847 @example
6848 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6849 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6850 @end example
6851
6852 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6853 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6854 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6855 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6856 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6857 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6858 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6859 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6860 @end deffn
6861 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6862 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6863 This will remove any Code Protection.
6864 @end deffn
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6868 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6869 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6870 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6871 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6872
6873 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6874 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6875
6876 @example
6877 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6878 @end example
6879
6880 psoc4-specific commands
6881 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6882 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6883
6884 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6885 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6886
6887 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6888 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6889 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6890
6891 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6895 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6896
6897 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6898 @end deffn
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6902 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6903 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6904 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6905 apart from the base address.
6906
6907 @example
6908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6909 @end example
6910
6911 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6912 @quotation Attention
6913 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6914 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6915 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6916 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6917 @end quotation
6918
6919 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6920
6921 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6922 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6923 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6924 @end deffn
6925 @end deffn
6926
6927 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6928 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6929 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6930 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6931 apart from the base address.
6932
6933 @example
6934 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6935 $_TARGETNAME
6936 @end example
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6940 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6941 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6942 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6943
6944 @example
6945 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6946 @end example
6947
6948 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6949
6950 @itemize
6951 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6952 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6953 @end itemize
6954
6955 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6956
6957 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6958 @quotation Attention
6959 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6960 after successful write.
6961 @end quotation
6962 @end deffn
6963
6964 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6965 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6966 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6967 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6968
6969 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6970 @itemize @bullet
6971 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6972 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6973 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6974 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6975 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6976 row size: 512 bytes.
6977 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6978 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6979 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6980 operation will erase row automatically.
6981 @end itemize
6982
6983 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6984 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6985
6986 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6987
6988 @example
6989 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6990 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6991 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6992 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6993 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6994 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6995 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6996 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6997 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6998 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6999 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7000 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7001
7002 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7003 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7004 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7005 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7006 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7007 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7008 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7009 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7010 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7011 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7012 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7013 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7014 @end example
7015
7016 psoc6-specific commands
7017 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7018 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7019 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7020 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7021 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7022 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7023 @end deffn
7024
7025 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7026 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7027 by @command{flash banks}.
7028 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7029 @end deffn
7030 @end deffn
7031
7032 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7033 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7034 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7035 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7036 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7037
7038 @example
7039 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7040 @end example
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7044 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7045 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7046 and SWD interface.
7047 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7048 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7049
7050 @example
7051 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7052 @end example
7053
7054 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7055
7056 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7057 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7058 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7059 @end deffn
7060
7061 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7062 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7063 @end deffn
7064 @end deffn
7065
7066 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7067 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7068 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7069 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7070 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7071
7072 @example
7073 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7074 @end example
7075
7076 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7077 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7078 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7079 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7080 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7081 disabled.
7082
7083 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7084 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7085 @quotation Warning
7086 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7087 applied to all of them.
7088 @end quotation
7089 @end deffn
7090 @end deffn
7091
7092 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7093 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7094 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0 and GD32F3x0 microcontroller
7095 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
7096 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7097 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7098
7099 @example
7100 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7101 @end example
7102
7103 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7104 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7105 the flash driver.
7106
7107 @example
7108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7109 @end example
7110
7111 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7112 as per the following example.
7113 @example
7114 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7115 @end example
7116
7117 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7118
7119 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7120 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7121 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7122 @end deffn
7123
7124 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7125 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7126 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7127 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7128 @end deffn
7129
7130 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7131 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7132 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7136 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7137 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7138 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7142 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7144 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7148 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7149 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7150 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7151 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7152 @end deffn
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7156 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7157 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7158 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7159 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7160
7161 @example
7162 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7163 @end example
7164
7165 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7166 as per the following example.
7167 @example
7168 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7169 @end example
7170
7171 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7172 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7173 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7177 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7178 the flash driver.
7179
7180 @example
7181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7182 @end example
7183
7184 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7185
7186 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7187 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7188 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7189 @end deffn
7190
7191 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7192 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7193 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7197 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7198 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7202 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7203 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7204 @end deffn
7205
7206 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7207 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7208 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7209 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7210 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7211 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7215 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7216 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7217 @end deffn
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7221 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7222 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7223 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7224 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7225
7226 @example
7227 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7228 @end example
7229
7230 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7231 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7232 the flash driver.
7233
7234 @example
7235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7236 @end example
7237
7238 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7239
7240 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7241 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7242 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7246 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7247 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7248 @end deffn
7249
7250 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7251 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7253 @end deffn
7254
7255 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7256 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7257 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7258 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7259 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7260
7261 Example usage:
7262 @example
7263 # read OPTSR_CUR
7264 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7265 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7266 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7267 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7268 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7269 @end example
7270 @end deffn
7271
7272 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7273 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7275 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7276 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7277 will be touched).
7278
7279 Example usage:
7280 @example
7281 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7282 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7283 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7284 @end example
7285 @end deffn
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7289 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7290 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7291 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7292 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7293
7294 @example
7295 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7296 @end example
7297
7298 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7299 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7300 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7301 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7302 second bank.
7303
7304 @example
7305 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7306 @end example
7307
7308 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7309
7310 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7311 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7312 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7313 @end deffn
7314
7315 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7316 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7317 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7318 @end deffn
7319
7320 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7321 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7322 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7323 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7324 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7325 @end deffn
7326 @end deffn
7327
7328 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7329 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7330 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7331 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7332 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7333 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7334
7335 @example
7336 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7337 @end example
7338
7339 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7340 as per the following example.
7341 @example
7342 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7343 @end example
7344
7345 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7346 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7347 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7351 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7352 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7353 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7354
7355 @example
7356 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7357 @end example
7358
7359 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7360
7361 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7362 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7364
7365 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7366 @end deffn
7367
7368 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7369 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7371
7372 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7376 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7377 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7381 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7382 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7383 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7384
7385 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7386 @example
7387 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7388 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7389 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7390 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7391 @end example
7392
7393 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7394 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7398 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7399 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7400 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7401 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7402
7403 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7404
7405 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7406 @example
7407 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7408 @end example
7409
7410 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7411 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7412 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7413 @end deffn
7414
7415 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7416 List the protected areas using WRP.
7417 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7418 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7419 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7420
7421 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7422 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7423 in single or dual-banks mode.
7424 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7425 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7426
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7430 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7431 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7432 @end deffn
7433
7434 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7435 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7436 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7437 the TrustZone status.
7438 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7439 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7440 @end deffn
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7444 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7445 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7446 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7447 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7448
7449 @example
7450 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7451 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7452 @end example
7453
7454 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7455 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7456 for the specified flash bank.
7457 @end deffn
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7461 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7462 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7463 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7464 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7465
7466 @example
7467 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7468 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7469 @end example
7470
7471 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7472 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7473 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7474
7475 @itemize @bullet
7476 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7477 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7478 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7479 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7480 @end itemize
7481 @end deffn
7482
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7486 @cindex str9xpec
7487
7488 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7489 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7490 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7491 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7492
7493 Here is some background info to help
7494 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7495 the str9:
7496 @enumerate
7497 @item
7498 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7499 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7500 @item
7501 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7502 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7503 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7504 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7505 @end enumerate
7506
7507 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7508 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7509 configured for flash bank 0.
7510 @example
7511 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7512 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7513 adapter assert srst
7514 # turn off target polling
7515 poll off
7516 # disable str9 core
7517 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7518 # read option bytes
7519 str9xpec options_read 0
7520 # re-enable str9 core
7521 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7522 poll on
7523 reset halt
7524 @end example
7525 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7526 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7527 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7528 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7529
7530 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7531
7532 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7533 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7534 @end deffn
7535
7536 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7537 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7538 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7539 @end deffn
7540
7541 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7542 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7543 erase the device.
7544 @end deffn
7545
7546 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7547 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7548 @end deffn
7549
7550 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7551 Configure str9 boot bank.
7552 @end deffn
7553
7554 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7555 Configure str9 lvd source.
7556 @end deffn
7557
7558 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7559 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7563 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7564 @end deffn
7565
7566 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7567 Read str9 option bytes.
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7571 Write str9 option bytes.
7572 @end deffn
7573
7574 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7575 unlock str9 device.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7581 @cindex swm050
7582 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7583
7584 @example
7585 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7586 @end example
7587
7588 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7589
7590 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7591 Erases the entire flash bank.
7592 @end deffn
7593
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596
7597 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7598 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7599 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7600 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7601
7602 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7603
7604 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7605 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7609 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7610 @end deffn
7611
7612 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7613 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7614 the flash clock.
7615 @end deffn
7616 @end deffn
7617
7618 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7619 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7620 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7621 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7622 correct bank config.
7623
7624 @example
7625 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7626 @end example
7627 @end deffn
7628
7629 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7630 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7631 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7632 @end deffn
7633
7634 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7635 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7636 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7637
7638 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7639
7640 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7641 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7645 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @section NAND Flash Commands
7651 @cindex NAND
7652
7653 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7654 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7655 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7656
7657 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7658 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7659 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7660 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7661 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7662 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7663
7664 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7665 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7666 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7667 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7668 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7669 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7670 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7671 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7672 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7673 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7674
7675 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7676 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7677 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7678 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7679 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7680 every 512 bytes of data.
7681
7682 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7683 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7684 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7685 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7686 ECC mode is used.
7687
7688 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7689 @enumerate
7690 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7691 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7692 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7693 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7694 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7695 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7696 to access that device.
7697 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7698 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7699 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7700 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7701 de-brick a board.
7702 @end enumerate
7703
7704 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7705 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7706 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7707 are only 32 bits wide.
7708 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7709 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7710 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7711 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7712
7713 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7714 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7715 @cindex NAND configuration
7716
7717 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7718 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7719 OpenOCD has initialized.
7720
7721 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7722 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7723 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7724 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7725 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7726 they were a single (larger) device.
7727 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7728 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7729
7730 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7731 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7732 configuration files, not interactively.
7733
7734 @itemize @bullet
7735 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7736 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7737 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7738 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7739 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7740 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7741 commands to the NAND controller.
7742 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7743 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7744 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7745 for more information.
7746 @end itemize
7747 @end deffn
7748
7749 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7750 Prints a summary of each device declared
7751 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7752 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7753 @example
7754 > nand list
7755 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7756 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7757 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7758 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7759 >
7760 @end example
7761 @end deffn
7762
7763 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7764 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7765 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7766 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7767 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7768 it with most other NAND commands.
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7772
7773 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7774 @cindex NAND reading
7775 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7776 starting at the specified offset.
7777 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7778
7779 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7780 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7781
7782 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7783 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7784 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7785
7786 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7787 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7788 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7789 method which handled that error correction.
7790
7791 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7792 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7793 @itemize @bullet
7794 @item no oob_* parameter
7795 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7796 @item @code{oob_raw}
7797 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7798 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7799 spare areas associated with each data page.
7800 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7801 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7802 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7803 @item @code{oob_only}
7804 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7805 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7806 spare areas associated with each data page.
7807 @end itemize
7808 @end deffn
7809
7810 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7811 @cindex NAND erasing
7812 @cindex NAND programming
7813 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7814 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7815 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7816 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7817 If those parameters are not specified,
7818 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7819 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7820
7821 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7822 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7823 block marker.
7824 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7825 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7826 @end deffn
7827
7828 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7829 @cindex NAND writing
7830 @cindex NAND programming
7831 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7832 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7833 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7834 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7835
7836 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7837 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7838
7839 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7840 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7841 past the end of the device.
7842 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7843 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7844 if that's being written.)
7845
7846 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7847 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7848 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7849
7850 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7851 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7852 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7853 @itemize @bullet
7854 @item no oob_* parameter
7855 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7856 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7857 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7858 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7859 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7860 @item @code{oob_only}
7861 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7862 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7863 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7864 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7865 @item @code{oob_raw}
7866 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7867 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7868 un-altered OOB.
7869 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7870 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7871 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7872 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7873 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7874 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7875 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7876 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7877 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7878 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7879 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7880 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7881 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7882 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7883 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7884 @end itemize
7885 @end deffn
7886
7887 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7888 @cindex NAND verification
7889 @cindex NAND programming
7890 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7891 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7892 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7893
7894 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7895 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7896
7897 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7898 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7899 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7900 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7901 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7902
7903 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7904 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7905 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7906
7907 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7908 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7909 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7910 be removed in a future release.
7911 @end deffn
7912
7913 @subsection Other NAND commands
7914 @cindex NAND other commands
7915
7916 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7917 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7918 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7919 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7920 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7921 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7922 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7923 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7924
7925 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7926 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7927 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7928 @end deffn
7929
7930 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7931 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7932 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7933 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7934 status for each block.
7935 @end deffn
7936
7937 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7938 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7939 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7940
7941 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7942 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7943 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7944 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7945 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7946
7947 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7948 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7949 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7950 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7951 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7952 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7953 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7957 @subsection NAND Driver List
7958 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7959 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7960 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7961
7962 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7963 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7964 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7965 address of the ECC controller.
7966 @example
7967 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7968 @end example
7969 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7970 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7971 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7972 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7973 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7974 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7975 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7976 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7977 @end deffn
7978 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7979 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7980 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7984 properly configured for input or output.
7985 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7986 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7987 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7988 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7989 @end deffn
7990 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7991 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7992 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7993 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7994 @end deffn
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7998 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7999 chips from Texas Instruments.
8000 It takes three extra parameters:
8001 address of the NAND chip;
8002 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8003 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8004 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8005 @example
8006 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8007 @end example
8008 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8009 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8010 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8011 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8012 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8013 @end deffn
8014
8015 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8016 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8017 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8018 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8019 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8020 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8021 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8022 @end deffn
8023
8024 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8025 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8026 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8027 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8028 @end deffn
8029 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8030
8031 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8032 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8033 should work for this chip as well.
8034 @end deffn
8035
8036 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8037 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8038 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8039 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8040 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8041 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8042 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8043 @example
8044 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8045 @end example
8046 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8047 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8048 without parameter query status.
8049 @end deffn
8050 @end deffn
8051
8052 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8053 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8054 parameter: the address of the controller.
8055 @example
8056 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8057 @end example
8058 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8059 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8060 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8061 change any behavior.
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8065 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8066 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8067 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8068 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8069 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8070 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8071 specialized commands.
8072 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8073 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8074 change any behavior.
8075 @end deffn
8076
8077 @node Flash Programming
8078 @chapter Flash Programming
8079
8080 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8081 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8082 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8083
8084 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8085 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8086
8087 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8088 @enumerate
8089 @item 'init' is executed.
8090 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8091 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8092 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8093 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8094 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8095 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8096 @end enumerate
8097
8098 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8099
8100 @example
8101 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8102 # are optional parameters
8103 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8104 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8105
8106 # binary files need the flash address passing
8107 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8108 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8109 @end example
8110
8111 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8112 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8113 @cindex PLD
8114 @cindex FPGA
8115
8116 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8117 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8118 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8119 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8120 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8121 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8122 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8123
8124 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8125
8126 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8127 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8128 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8129
8130 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8131 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8132
8133 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8134 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8135 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8136 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8137 behavior.
8138 @end deffn
8139
8140 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8141 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8142 @end deffn
8143
8144 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8145 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8146 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8147 @end deffn
8148
8149 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8150
8151 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8152 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8153 that particular type of PLD.
8154
8155 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8156 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8157 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8158
8159 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8160 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8161 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8162
8163 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8164 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8165 for FPGA @var{num}.
8166 @end deffn
8167 @end deffn
8168
8169 @node General Commands
8170 @chapter General Commands
8171 @cindex commands
8172
8173 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8174 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8175 commands are documented elsewhere.
8176
8177 Intent:
8178 @itemize @bullet
8179 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8180 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8181 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8182 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8183
8184 @item @b{From the human}
8185 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8186 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8187
8188 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8189 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8190 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8191
8192 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8193 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8194 port is 5555.
8195 @end itemize
8196
8197
8198 @section Server Commands
8199
8200 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8201 Exits the current telnet session.
8202 @end deffn
8203
8204 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8205 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8206 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8207 Not every command provides helptext.
8208
8209 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8210 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8211 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8212 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8213 @end deffn
8214
8215 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8216 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8217 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8218 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8219 Useful in connection with script files
8220 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8221 @end deffn
8222
8223 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8224 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8225 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8226 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8227
8228 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8229 @example
8230 # redefine shutdown
8231 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8232 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8233 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8234 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8235 original_shutdown
8236 @}
8237 @end example
8238 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8239 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @anchor{debuglevel}
8243 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8244 @cindex message level
8245 Display debug level.
8246 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8247 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8248 Level 0 is error messages only;
8249 level 1 adds warnings;
8250 level 2 adds informational messages;
8251 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8252 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8253 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8254 the command line along with the location of that log
8255 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8256 @xref{Running}.
8257 @end deffn
8258
8259 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8260 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8261 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8262 @example
8263 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8264 @end example
8265 @end deffn
8266
8267 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8268 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8269 the default log output channel is stderr.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8273 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8277 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8278 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8279 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8280 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8281 @end deffn
8282
8283 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8284 @section Target State handling
8285 @cindex reset
8286 @cindex halt
8287 @cindex target initialization
8288
8289 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8290 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8291 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8292 a current target which is used to perform the
8293 various operations. The current target may be changed
8294 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8295 target which should become current.
8296
8297 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8298 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8299 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8300 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8301 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8302
8303 @emph{With no arguments}:
8304 list all available registers for the current target,
8305 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8306 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8307 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8308 are flagged as such.
8309
8310 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8311 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8312 bypassing any internal cache.
8313
8314 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8315 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8316 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8317 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8318 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8319 relevant module will flush such values.
8320
8321 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8322 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8323
8324 @example
8325 > reg
8326 ===== ARM registers
8327 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8328 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8329 (2) r2 (/32)
8330 ...
8331 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8332 >
8333 @end example
8334 @end deffn
8335
8336 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8337 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8338 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8339 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8340 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8341 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8342 (and enter debug mode).
8343 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8344
8345 @quotation Warning
8346 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8347 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8348 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8349 power mode by gating the core clock;
8350 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8351
8352 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8353 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8354 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8355 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8356 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8357 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8358
8359 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8360 work with a JTAG debugger.
8361 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8362 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8363 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8364 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8365 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8366 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8367 @end quotation
8368
8369 @end deffn
8370
8371 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8372 Resume the target at its current code position,
8373 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8374 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8378 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8379 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @anchor{resetcommand}
8383 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8384 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8385 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8386 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8387 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8388 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8389 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8390
8391 The optional parameter specifies what should
8392 happen after the reset.
8393 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8394 The other options will not work on all systems.
8395 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8396
8397 @itemize @minus
8398 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8399 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8400 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8401 @end itemize
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8405 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8406 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8407 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8408 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8409 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8410 state.
8411 @end deffn
8412
8413 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8414 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8415 Set values of reset signals.
8416 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8417 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8418 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8419 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8420
8421 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8422 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8423 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8424 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8425 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8426 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8427 the signal will not be modified.
8428
8429 @quotation Note
8430 TRST is specially handled.
8431 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8432 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8433 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8434 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8435 instead of the TRST signal.
8436 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8437 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8438 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8439 with handlers for that event.
8440 @end quotation
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8444 @section Memory access commands
8445 @cindex memory access
8446
8447 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8448 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8449 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8450 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8451
8452 @enumerate
8453 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8454 to change the current target.
8455 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8456 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8457 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8458 @end enumerate
8459
8460 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8461 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8462 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8463 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8464 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8465 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8466 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8467 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8468 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8469 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8470 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8471 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8472 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8473 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8474 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8475 @end deffn
8476
8477 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8478 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8479 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8480 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8481 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8482 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8483 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8484 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8485 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8486 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8487 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8488 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8489 @end deffn
8490
8491 @anchor{imageaccess}
8492 @section Image loading commands
8493 @cindex image loading
8494 @cindex image dumping
8495
8496 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8497 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8498 binary file named @var{filename}.
8499 @end deffn
8500
8501 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8502 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8503 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8504 @end deffn
8505
8506 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8507 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8508 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8509 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8510 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8511 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8512 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8513 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8514 separately.
8515 @end deffn
8516
8517 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8518 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8519 The file format may optionally be specified
8520 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8521 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8522 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8523 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8524 @example
8525 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8526 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8527 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8528 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8529 $address $length
8530 @}
8531 @end example
8532 @end deffn
8533
8534 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8535 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8536 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8537 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8538 The file format may optionally be specified
8539 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8543 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8544 The file format may optionally be specified
8545 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8546 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8550 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8551 The file format may optionally be specified
8552 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8553 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8554 @end deffn
8555
8556
8557 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8558 @cindex breakpoint
8559 @cindex watchpoint
8560
8561 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8562 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8563 watchpoints.
8564 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8565
8566 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8567 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8568 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8569 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8570 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8571 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8572
8573 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8574 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8575 @end deffn
8576
8577 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8578 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8579 @end deffn
8580
8581 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8582 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8586 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8587 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8588 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8589 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8590 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8591 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8592 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8593 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8594 @end deffn
8595
8596
8597 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8598
8599 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8600 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8601 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8602 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8603 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8604 running, can be used.
8605 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8606 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8607 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8608
8609 @quotation Note
8610 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8611 @end quotation
8612
8613 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8614 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8615 communication, respectively.
8616
8617 @quotation Note
8618 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8619 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8620 example.
8621 @end quotation
8622
8623 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8624 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8625 of TCP/IP connections.
8626
8627 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8628 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8629 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8630 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8631 @var{size} bytes.
8632 @end deffn
8633
8634 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8635 Start RTT.
8636 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8637 @end deffn
8638
8639 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8640 Stop RTT.
8641 @end deffn
8642
8643 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8644 Display the polling interval.
8645 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8646 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8647 checked for new data.
8648 @end deffn
8649
8650 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8651 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8652 @end deffn
8653
8654 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8655 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8656 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8660 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8661 @end deffn
8662
8663 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8664 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8665 @end deffn
8666
8667 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8668 on the target device.
8669
8670 @example
8671 resume
8672
8673 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8674 rtt start
8675
8676 rtt server start 9090 0
8677 @end example
8678
8679 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8680 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8681 TCP/IP port 9090.
8682
8683
8684 @section Misc Commands
8685
8686 @cindex profiling
8687 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8688 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8689 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8690 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8691 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8692 limit the address range.
8693 @end deffn
8694
8695 @deffn {Command} {version}
8696 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8697 @end deffn
8698
8699 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8700 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8701 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8705 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8706 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8707 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8708
8709 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8710 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8711 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8712 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8713
8714 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8715 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8716 @cindex tracing
8717 @cindex ETM
8718 @cindex ETB
8719
8720 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8721 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8722 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8723
8724 @itemize
8725 @item
8726 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8727 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8728 supports such an interface.
8729 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8730 and trace port support.)
8731 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8732 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8733 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8734 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8735 in the board-specific configuration file.
8736 @item
8737 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8738 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8739 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8740 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8741 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8742 @end itemize
8743
8744 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8745
8746 @quotation Issues
8747 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8748 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8749
8750 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8751 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8752 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8753 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8754 dummy trace port driver}.
8755
8756 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8757 as well as tracing only during specific states
8758 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8759
8760 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8761 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8762 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8763 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8764 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8765
8766 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8767 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8768 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8769 this original style of JTAG access.
8770 @end quotation
8771
8772 @subsection ETM Configuration
8773 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8774
8775 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8776 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8777 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8778
8779 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8780 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8781 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8782 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8783 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8784 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8785 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8786 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8787 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8788
8789 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8790 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8791 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8792
8793 @quotation Warning
8794 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8795 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8796 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8797 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8798 @end quotation
8799
8800 @quotation Note
8801 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8802 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8803 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8804 what CPU activities are traced.
8805 @end quotation
8806 @end deffn
8807
8808 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8809 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8810 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8811 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8812 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8813 @end deffn
8814
8815 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8816 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8817 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8818 Did trace data overflow?
8819 Was it triggered?
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8823 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8824 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8825 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8826 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8827
8828 @itemize
8829 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8830 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8831 The value is one of
8832 @option{none} (save nothing),
8833 @option{data} (save data),
8834 @option{address} (save addresses),
8835 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8836 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8837 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8838 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8839 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8840 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8841 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8842 trace stream without an image of the code.
8843 @end itemize
8844 @end deffn
8845
8846 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8847 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8848 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8849 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8850 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8851
8852 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8853 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8854 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8855 @end deffn
8856
8857 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8858
8859 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8860 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8861 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8862
8863 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8864 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8865 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8866 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8867 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8868 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8869 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8870
8871 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8872
8873 @itemize
8874 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8875 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8876 for instruction access within that function's body.
8877 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8878 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8879 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8880 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8881 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8882 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8883 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8884 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8885 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8886 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8887 @item @emph{... more}
8888 @end itemize
8889
8890 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8891 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8892
8893 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8894 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8895 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8899 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8903 Opens an image file.
8904 @end deffn
8905
8906 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8907 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8908 @end deffn
8909
8910 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8911 Starts trace data collection.
8912 @end deffn
8913
8914 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8915 Stops trace data collection.
8916 @end deffn
8917
8918 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8919 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8920
8921 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8922
8923 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8924 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8925 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8926 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8927 any trace data collection.}
8928 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8929 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8930 @end deffn
8931 @end deffn
8932
8933 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8934 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8935 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8936 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8937 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8938 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8939 @end deffn
8940 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8941 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8942 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8943 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8944 trace trigger becomes active.
8945
8946 @itemize
8947 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8948 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8949 afterwards.
8950 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8951 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8952 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8953 what caused that event to happen.
8954 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8955 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8956 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8957 how the event caused trouble.
8958 @end itemize
8959 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @end deffn
8963
8964 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8965 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8966 @cindex CTI
8967
8968 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8969 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8970 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8971 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8972 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8973 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8974
8975 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8976 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8977 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8978 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8979 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8980 including additional configuration.
8981 @end deffn
8982
8983 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8984 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8985 @end deffn
8986
8987 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8988 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8989 @end deffn
8990
8991 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8992 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8993 @end deffn
8994
8995 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8996 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8997 @end deffn
8998
8999 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9000 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9001 @end deffn
9002
9003 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9004 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9005 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9006 @end deffn
9007
9008 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9009 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9010 of the CTI.
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9014 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9015 useful in TCL scripting.
9016 @end deffn
9017
9018 @section Generic ARM
9019 @cindex ARM
9020
9021 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9022 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9023 commands that may be available.
9024
9025 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9026 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9027 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9028 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9029 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9030 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9034 @cindex disassemble
9035 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9036 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9037 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9038 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9039 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9040 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9041 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9042
9043 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9044 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9045 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9046 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9047 with a handful of exceptions.
9048 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9049 @end deffn
9050
9051 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9052 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9053 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9054 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9055 and using the MCR instruction.
9056 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9057 an ARM register.)
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9061 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9062 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9063 and the MRC instruction.
9064 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9065 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9066 an ARM register.)
9067 @end deffn
9068
9069 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9070 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9071 core mode if necessary.
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9075 @cindex ARM semihosting
9076 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9077
9078 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9079 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9080 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9081 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9082 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9083 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9084 @end deffn
9085
9086 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9087 @cindex ARM semihosting
9088 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9089
9090 @example
9091 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9092 @end example
9093
9094 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9095 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9096 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9097 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9098 @end deffn
9099
9100 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9101 @cindex ARM semihosting
9102 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9103 status.
9104
9105 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9106 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9107 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9108 debugger.
9109 @end deffn
9110
9111 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9112 @cindex ARM semihosting
9113 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9114
9115 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9116 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9117 the value returned by the target.
9118
9119 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9120 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9121 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9122 encountering a break.
9123
9124 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9125 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9126 to the debugger.
9127 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9128 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9129 request or equivalent").
9130
9131 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9132 this option (default: disabled).
9133 @end deffn
9134
9135 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9136 @cindex ARMv4
9137 @cindex ARMv5
9138
9139 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9140 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9141 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9142 variant.
9143
9144 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9145 @cindex ARM7
9146 @cindex ARM9
9147
9148 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9149 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9150 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9151 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9152
9153 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9154 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9155 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9156 instead of breakpoints.
9157 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9158
9159 This should be
9160 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9161 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9162 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9166 @cindex DCC
9167 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9168 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9169 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9170
9171 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9172 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9173 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9174 @end deffn
9175
9176 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9177 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9178 that don't check completion of the operation.
9179 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9180
9181 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9182 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9183 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9184 @end deffn
9185
9186 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9187 @cindex ARM9
9188
9189 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9190 integer processors.
9191 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9192
9193 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9194 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9195 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9196 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9197
9198 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9199 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9200 @cindex vector_catch
9201 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9202 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9203 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9204 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9205 to those hardware vectors.
9206
9207 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9208 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9209 vector catch hardware to intercept
9210 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9211 @option{none} of them,
9212 or a list with one or more of the following:
9213 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9214 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9215 @end deffn
9216
9217 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9218 @cindex ARM920T
9219
9220 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9221 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9222 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9223 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9224 and ARM9 commands.
9225
9226 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9227 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9228 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9229 @end deffn
9230
9231 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9232 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9233 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9234 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9235 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9236 (Not all registers can be written.)
9237 @end deffn
9238
9239 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9240 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9241 @end deffn
9242
9243 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9244 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9245 @end deffn
9246
9247 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9248 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9249
9250 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9251 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9252 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9253 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9254 and ARM9 commands.
9255
9256 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9257 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9258
9259 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9260 Print information about the caches found.
9261 @end deffn
9262
9263 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9264 @cindex ARM966E
9265
9266 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9267 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9268 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9269 and ARM9 commands.
9270
9271 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9272 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9273 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9274 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9275 ARM966E-S TRM.
9276 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9277 as required for BIST support.
9278 @end deffn
9279
9280 @subsection XScale specific commands
9281 @cindex XScale
9282
9283 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9284
9285 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9286 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9287 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9288 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9289 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9290 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9291 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9292
9293 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9294 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9295 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9296 the mini-IC.
9297
9298 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9299 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9300 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9301 code layout in memory:
9302 @example
9303 _vectors:
9304 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9305 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9306 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9307 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9308 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9309 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9310 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9311 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9312 .org 0x100
9313 .long real_reset_vector
9314 .long real_ui_handler
9315 .long real_swi_handler
9316 .long real_pf_abort
9317 .long real_data_abort
9318 .long 0 /* unused */
9319 .long real_irq_handler
9320 .long real_fiq_handler
9321 @end example
9322
9323 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9324 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9325 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9326 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9327 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9328 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9329 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9330 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9331 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9332 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9333 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9334 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9335 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9336 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9337 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9338 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9339 software.
9340
9341 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9342 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9343 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9344 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9345
9346 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9347 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9348 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9349 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9350 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9351 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9352 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9353 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9354 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9355
9356 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9357 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9358
9359 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9360 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9361 @end deffn
9362
9363 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9364 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9365 @end deffn
9366
9367 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9368 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9369 @end deffn
9370
9371 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9372 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9373 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9374 @end deffn
9375
9376 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9377 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9381 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9385 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9386 @end deffn
9387
9388 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9389 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9393 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9394 @end deffn
9395
9396 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9397 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9398 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9399 and modifying how it is emptied.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9403 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9404 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9405 The image @var{type} may be one of
9406 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9407 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9408 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9409 @end deffn
9410
9411 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9412 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9413 @cindex vector_catch
9414 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9415 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9416
9417 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9418 @example
9419 0x01 Trap Reset
9420 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9421 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9422 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9423 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9424 0x20 reserved
9425 0x40 Trap IRQ
9426 0x80 Trap FIQ
9427 @end example
9428 @end deffn
9429
9430 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9431 @cindex vector_table
9432
9433 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9434 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9435 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9436 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9437 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9438
9439 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9440
9441 @end deffn
9442
9443 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9444 @cindex ARMv6
9445
9446 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9447 @cindex ARM11
9448
9449 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9450 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9451 which is enabled by default.
9452 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9453 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9454 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9455 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9456 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9457 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9458 @end deffn
9459
9460 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9461 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9462 which is enabled by default.
9463 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9464 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9465 @end deffn
9466
9467 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9468 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9469 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9470 they are disabled by default.
9471 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9475 @cindex vector_catch
9476 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9477 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9478 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9479
9480 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9481 for certain hardware events.
9482 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9483 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9484 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9485 @end deffn
9486
9487 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9488 @cindex ARMv7
9489 @cindex ARMv8
9490
9491 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9492 @cindex Cortex-A
9493
9494 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9495 display information about target caches
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9499 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9500 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9501 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9502 Defaults to 'off'.
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9506 Initialize core debug
9507 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9511 Display/set the current SMP mode
9512 @end deffn
9513
9514 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9515 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9516 @end deffn
9517
9518 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9519 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9520 @end deffn
9521
9522 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9523 configure l2x cache
9524 @end deffn
9525
9526 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9527 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9528 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9529 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9530 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9531 @end deffn
9532
9533 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9534 @cindex Cortex-R
9535
9536 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r dbginit}
9537 Initialize core debug
9538 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9542 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545
9546 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9547 @cindex tracing
9548 @cindex SWO
9549 @cindex SWV
9550 @cindex TPIU
9551
9552 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9553 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9554 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9555 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9556
9557 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9558 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9559 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9560 which causes quite some confusion.
9561 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9562 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9563
9564 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9565 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9566 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9567
9568 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9569 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9570 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9571 @end deffn
9572
9573 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9574 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9575 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9576 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9577
9578 @itemize @bullet
9579 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9580 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9581 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9582 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9583
9584 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9585 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9586 @end itemize
9587 @end deffn
9588
9589 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9590 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9591 @end deffn
9592
9593 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9594 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9595 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9596 at any time after the initialization, too.
9597 @end deffn
9598
9599 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9600 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9601 individually queried, to return its current value.
9602 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9603 @end deffn
9604
9605 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9606 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9607 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9608 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9609
9610 @itemize @bullet
9611 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9612 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9613
9614 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9615 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9616
9617 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9618 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9619
9620 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9621 protocol used for trace data:
9622 @itemize @minus
9623 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9624 data bits (default);
9625 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9626 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9627 @end itemize
9628
9629 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9630 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9631 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9632 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9633 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9634 of the TPIU.
9635
9636 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9637 the destination of the trace data:
9638 @itemize @minus
9639 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9640 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9641 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9642 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9643 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9644 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9645 each connected client;
9646 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9647 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9648 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9649 @end itemize
9650
9651 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9652 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9653 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9654 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9655
9656 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9657 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9658 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9659 maximum supported rate automatically.
9660
9661 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9662 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9663 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9664
9665 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9666 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9667 default value is @var{0}.
9668 @end itemize
9669 @end deffn
9670
9671 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9672 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9673 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9674 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9675 data.
9676 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9677 after the @command{init}.
9678 @end deffn
9679
9680 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9681 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9682 @end deffn
9683
9684
9685
9686 Example usage:
9687 @enumerate
9688 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9689 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9690 enough to:
9691 @example
9692 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9693 ...
9694 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9695 ...
9696 @end example
9697 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9698 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9699 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9700 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9701 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9702 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9703 @example
9704 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9705 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9706 @end example
9707 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9708 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9709 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9710 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9711 @example
9712 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9713 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9714 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9715 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9716 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9717 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9718 @end example
9719 @end enumerate
9720
9721 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9722 @cindex tracing
9723 @cindex SWO
9724 @cindex SWV
9725 @cindex ITM
9726 @cindex ETM
9727
9728 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9729 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9730 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9731 @end deffn
9732
9733 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9734 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9735 @end deffn
9736
9737 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9738 @cindex Cortex-M
9739
9740 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9741 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9742
9743 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9744 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9745 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9746 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9747 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9748 the step command leaves with the core running.
9749
9750 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9751 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9752 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9753 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9754
9755 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9756 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9757 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9758 does.
9759
9760 Default is @option{auto}.
9761 @end deffn
9762
9763 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9764 @cindex vector_catch
9765 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9766 for certain hardware events.
9767
9768 Parameters request interception of
9769 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9770 @option{none} of them,
9771 or one or more of the following:
9772 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9773 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9774 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9775 @option{irq_err},
9776 @option{state_err},
9777 @option{chk_err}, or
9778 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9779 @option{reset}.
9780 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9781 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9782 are mapped to HardFault.
9783 UsageFault checks for
9784 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9785 must also be explicitly enabled.
9786
9787 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9788 @end deffn
9789
9790 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9791 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9792 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9793
9794 @itemize @minus
9795 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9796 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9797 @end itemize
9798
9799 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9800 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9801 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9802 to manually reset the peripherals.
9803 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9804
9805 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9806 instead.
9807 @end deffn
9808
9809 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9810 @cindex ARMv8-A
9811 @cindex aarch64
9812
9813 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9814 Display information about target caches
9815 @end deffn
9816
9817 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9818 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9819 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9820 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9821 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9822 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9823 @end deffn
9824
9825 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9826 @cindex disassemble
9827 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9828 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9832 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9833 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9834 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9835 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9836 @end deffn
9837
9838 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9839 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9840 @option{on}.
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9844 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9845 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9846 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9847 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9848 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9849 @end deffn
9850
9851 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9852
9853 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9854 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9855
9856 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9857
9858 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9859 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9860 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9864 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9865 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9866 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9867 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9868 @end deffn
9869
9870 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9871
9872 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9873 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9874 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9875 @end deffn
9876
9877 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9878
9879 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9880 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9881 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9882 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9883 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9884 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9885 can be collected.
9886
9887 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9888 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9889 tooling.
9890
9891 @quotation Issues
9892 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9893 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9894 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9895 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9896
9897 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9898 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9899 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9900 software operation on the CPU.
9901 @end quotation
9902
9903 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9904 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9905 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9906 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9910 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9911 @end deffn
9912
9913 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9914 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9915 control is disabled.
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9919 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9920 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9921 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9922
9923 Supported trace formats:
9924 @itemize
9925 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9926 timing to be determined.
9927 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9928 addresses.
9929 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9930 @end itemize
9931 @end deffn
9932
9933 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9934 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9935 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9936 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9937
9938 Supported conditions:
9939 @itemize
9940 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9941 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9942 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9943 instruction matches start data and mask.
9944 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9945 instruction matches start data and mask.
9946 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9947 data and mask.
9948 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9949 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9950 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9951 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9952 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9953 @end itemize
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9957 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9958 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9959 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9960
9961 Supported conditions:
9962 @itemize
9963 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9964 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9965 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9966 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9967 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9968 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9969 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9970 data and mask.
9971 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9972 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9973 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9974 @end itemize
9975 @end deffn
9976
9977 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9978 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9979
9980 Supported triggers:
9981 @itemize
9982 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9983 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9984 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9985 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9986 collection.
9987 @end itemize
9988 @end deffn
9989
9990 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9991
9992 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9993 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9994 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9995 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9996 @end deffn
9997
9998 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9999 Display trace configuration.
10000 @end deffn
10001
10002 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10003 Display trace collection status.
10004 @end deffn
10005
10006 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10007 Start manual trace collection.
10008 @end deffn
10009
10010 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10011 Stop manual trace collection.
10012 @end deffn
10013
10014 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10015 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10016 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10017 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10018 @option{size} options using DMA.
10019 @end deffn
10020
10021 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10022 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10023 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10024 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10025 @option{size} options using DMA.
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @section Intel Architecture
10029
10030 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10031 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10032 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10033 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10034 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10035 @itemize
10036 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10037 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10038 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10039 @end itemize
10040
10041 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10042 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10043 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10044
10045 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10046 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10047 @end deffn
10048
10049 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10050 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10051 @end deffn
10052
10053 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10054 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10055 @end deffn
10056
10057 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10058 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10059 @end deffn
10060
10061 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10062 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10063 @end deffn
10064
10065 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10066 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10067 @end deffn
10068
10069 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10070
10071 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10072 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10073
10074 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10075 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10076 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10077 @end deffn
10078 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10079 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10080
10081 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10082
10083 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10084 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10085 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10086 @end deffn
10087
10088 @subsection Registers commands
10089 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10090 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10091 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10092
10093 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10094
10095 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10096 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10097 and "timer" groups.
10098
10099 @emph{example:}
10100 @example
10101 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10102 @end example
10103
10104
10105 @end deffn
10106 @deffn {Command} {readgroup} (@option{group})
10107 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
10108
10109 @emph{group} can be "system",
10110 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
10111 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
10112 @end deffn
10113
10114 @section RISC-V Architecture
10115
10116 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10117 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10118 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10119 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10120 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10121 implement version 0.11.
10122
10123 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10124
10125 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10126 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10127 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10128
10129 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10130
10131 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10132 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10133 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10134
10135 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10136 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10137 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10138 CSRs.
10139 @end deffn
10140
10141 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10142 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10143 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10144 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10145 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10146 This command must be executed before `init`.
10147 @end deffn
10148
10149 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10150 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10151 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10152 @end deffn
10153
10154 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10155 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10156 deasserted.
10157 @end deffn
10158
10159 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10160 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10161 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10162 @end deffn
10163
10164 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10165 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10166 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10167 @end deffn
10168
10169 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10170 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10171 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10172 on physical memory.
10173 @end deffn
10174
10175 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10176 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10177 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10178 performed on physical memory.
10179 @end deffn
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10182 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10183 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10184 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10185 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10186 race condition problem in your code.
10187
10188 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10189 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10193 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10194 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10195 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10196 values.
10197
10198 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10199 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10200 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10201 @end deffn
10202
10203 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10204 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10205 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10206 @end deffn
10207
10208 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10209 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10210 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10214 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10215 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10216 @end deffn
10217
10218 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10219 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10220 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10221 @end deffn
10222
10223 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10224
10225 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10226 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10227 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10228 @example
10229 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10230 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10231 @end example
10232
10233 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10234 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10235 @end deffn
10236
10237 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10238 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10239 @end deffn
10240
10241 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10242
10243 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10244 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10247 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10248 @end deffn
10249
10250 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10251 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10252 @end deffn
10253
10254 @section ARC Architecture
10255 @cindex ARC
10256
10257 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10258 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10259 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10260 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10261 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10262 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10263 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10264 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10265 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10266 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10267 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10268 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10269 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10270 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10271 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10272
10273
10274 @subsection General ARC commands
10275
10276 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10277
10278 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10279 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10280 arguments:
10281
10282 @itemize @bullet
10283
10284 @item @code{-name} name
10285 @*Name of a register.
10286
10287 @item @code{-num} number
10288 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10289
10290 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10291 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10292
10293 @end itemize
10294
10295 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10296
10297 @itemize @bullet
10298
10299 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10300 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10301 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10302 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10303 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10304 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10305
10306 @item @code{-core}
10307 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10308 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10309 spaces.
10310
10311 @item @code{-bcr}
10312 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10313 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10314 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10315 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10316 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10317
10318 @item @code{-type} type_name
10319 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10320 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10321
10322 @item @code{-g}
10323 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10324 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10325 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10326 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10327 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10328
10329 @end itemize
10330
10331 @end deffn
10332
10333 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10334 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10335 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10336 @end deffn
10337
10338 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10339 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10340 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10341 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10342 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10343 startbit endbit}.
10344 @end deffn
10345
10346 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10347 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10348 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10349 @end deffn
10350
10351 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10352 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10353 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10354 @end deffn
10355
10356 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10357
10358 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10359 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10360 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10361 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10362
10363 @end deffn
10364
10365 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10366 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10367 registers.
10368 @end deffn
10369
10370 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10371 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10372 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10373 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10374
10375 @end deffn
10376
10377 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10378 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10379 registers.
10380 @end deffn
10381
10382 @section STM8 Architecture
10383 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10384 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10385
10386 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10387 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10388
10389 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10390 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10391 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10392 @cindex tracing
10393 @cindex libdcc
10394 @cindex DCC
10395 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10396 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10397 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10398 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10399
10400 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10401 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10402 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10403 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10404 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10405 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10406
10407 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10408 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10409 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10410 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10411 The target being debugged may
10412 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10413 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10414 each supported by a command:
10415
10416 @itemize
10417 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10418 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10419 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10420 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10421
10422 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10423 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10424 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10425
10426 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10427 and then displayed at any time.
10428 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10429
10430 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10431 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10432 @end itemize
10433
10434 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10435 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10436 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10437 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10438 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10439 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10440 does the same thing.
10441
10442 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10443 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10444 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10445 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10446 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10447
10448 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10449 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10450 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10451 @end deffn
10452
10453 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10454 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10455 in the order they triggered.
10456 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10457 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10458 history records.
10459 @end deffn
10460
10461 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10462 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10463 they have been triggered.
10464 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10465 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10466 and associates it with that identifier.
10467
10468 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10469 are not related except by this command.
10470 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10471 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10472 @end deffn
10473
10474
10475 @node JTAG Commands
10476 @chapter JTAG Commands
10477 @cindex JTAG Commands
10478 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10479 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10480 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10481 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10482 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10483
10484 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10485 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10486
10487 @itemize @bullet
10488 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10489 devices such as a CPUs.
10490 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10491 standard state machine (in parallel)
10492 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10493 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10494 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10495 while the reading previous ones.
10496 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10497 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10498 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10499 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10500 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10501 registers.
10502 @end itemize
10503
10504 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10505
10506 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10507 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10508 the order of TAP state transitions.
10509 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10510 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10511 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10512 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10513 these commands are not available.
10514
10515 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10516 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10517 that specify the entire register.
10518 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10519 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10520 The return value holds the original value of each
10521 of those fields.
10522
10523 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10524 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10525 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10526 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10527 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10528
10529 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10530 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10531
10532 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10533 in that state.
10534 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10535 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10536 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10537
10538 @quotation Warning
10539 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10540 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10541 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10542 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10543 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10544 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10545 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10546 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10547 @end quotation
10548 @end deffn
10549
10550 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10551 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10552 This may be used for performance tuning.
10553
10554 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10555 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10556 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10557 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10558 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10559 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10560 @end deffn
10561
10562 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10563 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10564 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10565 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10566 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10567 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10568
10569 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10570 in that state.
10571 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10572 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10573 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10574
10575 @quotation Note
10576 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10577 register values, unlike data register values.
10578 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10579 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10580 @end quotation
10581 @end deffn
10582
10583 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10584 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10585 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10586 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10587 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10588 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10589 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10590 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10591 The final state must also be stable.
10592 @end deffn
10593
10594 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10595 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10596 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10597 Instructions often need some time
10598 to execute before they take effect.
10599 @end deffn
10600
10601 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10602 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10603
10604 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10605 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10606 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10607 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10608 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10609 @end deffn
10610
10611 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10612 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10613 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10614 must also be enabled.
10615 Default is enabled.
10616 @end deffn
10617
10618 @section TAP state names
10619 @cindex TAP state names
10620
10621 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10622 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10623 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10624 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10625
10626 @itemize @bullet
10627 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10628 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10629 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10630 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10631 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10632 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10633 through the data register
10634 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10635 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10636 for update or more shifting
10637 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10638 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10639 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10640 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10641 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10642 through the instruction register
10643 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10644 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10645 for update or more shifting
10646 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10647 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10648 @end itemize
10649
10650 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10651 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10652 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10653 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10654
10655 @itemize @bullet
10656 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10657 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10658 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10659 may not be as expected.
10660 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10661 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10662 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10663 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10664 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10665 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10666 @end itemize
10667
10668 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10669 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10670
10671 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10672 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10673 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10674 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10675
10676 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10677 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10678 @cindex SVF
10679
10680 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10681 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10682 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10683 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10684
10685 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10686 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10687 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10688 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10689
10690 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10691 affect their semantics.
10692
10693 Command options:
10694 @itemize @minus
10695 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10696 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10697 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10698 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10699 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10700 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10701 on the real interface;
10702 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10703 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10704 errors.
10705 @end itemize
10706 @end deffn
10707
10708 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10709 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10710 @cindex XSVF
10711
10712 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10713 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10714 Xilinx devices.
10715 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10716 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10717
10718 @quotation Important
10719 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10720 @end quotation
10721
10722 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10723 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10724 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10725 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10726 that TAP.
10727 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10728 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10729 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10730 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10731 @end deffn
10732
10733 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10734 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10735 after building the software.
10736 You may find them useful:
10737
10738 @itemize
10739 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10740 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10741 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10742 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10743 @end itemize
10744
10745 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10746 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10747 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10748 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10749 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10750 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10751 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10752
10753
10754 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10755 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10756 @cindex IPDBG
10757
10758 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10759 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10760 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10761 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10762 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10763 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10764
10765 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10766 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10767
10768 Command options:
10769 @itemize @bullet
10770 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10771 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10772 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10773 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10774 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10775 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10776 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10777 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10778 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10779 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10780 shift data through vir can be configured.
10781 @end itemize
10782 @end deffn
10783
10784 Examples:
10785 @example
10786 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10787 @end example
10788 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10789 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10790
10791 @example
10792 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10793 @end example
10794 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10795 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10796
10797 @node Utility Commands
10798 @chapter Utility Commands
10799 @cindex Utility Commands
10800
10801 @section RAM testing
10802 @cindex RAM testing
10803
10804 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10805 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10806 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10807 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10808 hardware problems.
10809
10810 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10811 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10812 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10813 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10814
10815 Load the memory testing functions with
10816
10817 @example
10818 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10819 @end example
10820
10821 to get access to the following facilities:
10822
10823 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10824 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10825 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10826 @end deffn
10827
10828 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10829 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10830 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10831 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10832 @end deffn
10833
10834 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10835 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10836 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10837 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10838 @end deffn
10839
10840 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10841 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10842 @end deffn
10843
10844 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10845 @cindex Firmware recovery
10846
10847 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10848 devices recovery with JTAG.
10849
10850 For quickstart instructions run:
10851 @example
10852 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10853 @end example
10854
10855 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10856 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10857 @cindex GDB
10858 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10859 to debug remote targets.
10860 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10861
10862 @itemize
10863 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10864 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10865 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10866 as shown in this chapter.
10867 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10868 that also will probably need to be configured.
10869 @end itemize
10870
10871 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10872 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10873 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10874 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10875 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10876 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10877
10878 @section Connecting to GDB
10879 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10880 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10881 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10882 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10883 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10884
10885 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10886
10887 @enumerate
10888 @item
10889 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10890 @example
10891 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10892 @end example
10893 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10894
10895 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10896 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10897 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10898
10899 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10900 remote command above that becomes:
10901 @example
10902 tar ext :3333
10903 @end example
10904
10905 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10906 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10907 available through the command:
10908 @example
10909 target remote localhost:3333
10910 @end example
10911
10912 @item
10913 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10914 @example
10915 target extended-remote | \
10916 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10917 @end example
10918 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10919 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10920 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10921 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10922 @end enumerate
10923
10924 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10925 GDB command line.
10926
10927 @section Sample GDB session startup
10928
10929 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10930 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10931 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10932 small ARM program.
10933 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10934 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10935
10936 @example
10937 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10938 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10939 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10940 ...
10941 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10942 ...
10943 (gdb) load
10944 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10945 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10946 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10947 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10948 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10949 (gdb) continue
10950 Continuing.
10951 ...
10952 @end example
10953
10954 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10955 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10956 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10957 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10958
10959 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10960
10961 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10962 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10963 packet size and the device's memory map.
10964 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10965 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10966 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10967
10968 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10969 You may need to set those up by hand.
10970 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10971 something like:
10972
10973 @example
10974 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10975 @end example
10976
10977 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10978
10979 @example
10980 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10981 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10982 @end example
10983
10984 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10985 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10986 do not have such restrictions.
10987
10988 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10989 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10990 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10991 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10992
10993 @section Programming using GDB
10994 @cindex Programming using GDB
10995 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10996
10997 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10998 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10999 @example
11000 gdb_memory_map disable
11001 @end example
11002 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11003 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11004 working area.
11005
11006 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11007 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11008 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11009 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11010
11011 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11012 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11013
11014 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11015 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11016 @example
11017 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11018 @end example
11019
11020 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11021 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11022
11023 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11024 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11025 will be used.
11026
11027 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11028 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11029 @example
11030 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11031 @end example
11032 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11033
11034 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11035 can be used.
11036
11037 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11038 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11039 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11040
11041 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11042 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11043 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11044
11045 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11046 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11047 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11048 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11049 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11050 without any intrusion of the target process.
11051
11052 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11053 Place following command after target configuration:
11054 @example
11055 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11056 @end example
11057
11058 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11059 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11060 @example
11061 gdb_memory_map disable
11062 @end example
11063
11064 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11065 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11066 @example
11067 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11068 @end example
11069
11070 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11071 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11072
11073 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11074 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11075 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11076 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11077
11078 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11079 previously shown variables.
11080
11081 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11082 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11083 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11084 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11085 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11086
11087 @section RTOS Support
11088 @cindex RTOS Support
11089 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11090
11091 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11092 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11093
11094 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11095 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11096 GDB commands.
11097
11098 @* An example setup is below:
11099
11100 @example
11101 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11102 @end example
11103
11104 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11105
11106 Currently supported rtos's include:
11107 @itemize @bullet
11108 @item @option{eCos}
11109 @item @option{ThreadX}
11110 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11111 @item @option{linux}
11112 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11113 @item @option{embKernel}
11114 @item @option{mqx}
11115 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11116 @item @option{nuttx}
11117 @item @option{RIOT}
11118 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11119 @item @option{Zephyr}
11120 @end itemize
11121
11122 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11123 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11124
11125 @table @code
11126 @item eCos symbols
11127 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11128 @item ThreadX symbols
11129 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11130 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11131 @raggedright
11132 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11133 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11134 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11135 @end raggedright
11136 @item linux symbols
11137 init_task.
11138 @item ChibiOS symbols
11139 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11140 @item embKernel symbols
11141 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11142 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11143 @item mqx symbols
11144 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11145 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11146 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11147 @item nuttx symbols
11148 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11149 @item RIOT symbols
11150 @raggedright
11151 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11152 _tcb_name_offset.
11153 @end raggedright
11154 @item Zephyr symbols
11155 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11156 @end table
11157
11158 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11159 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11160
11161 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11162 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11163
11164 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11165 along with the project:
11166
11167 @table @code
11168 @item FreeRTOS
11169 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11170 @item uC/OS-III
11171 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11172 @end table
11173
11174 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11175 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11176 @cindex SMP
11177 @cindex RTOS
11178 @cindex hwthread
11179 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11180 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11181 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11182 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11183 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11184 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11185 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11186 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11187 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11188
11189 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11190 @quotation Note
11191 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11192 @end quotation
11193
11194 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11195 @itemize @bullet
11196 @item j - smp status request
11197 @item J - smp set request
11198 @end itemize
11199
11200 OpenOCD implements :
11201 @itemize @bullet
11202 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11203 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11204 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11205 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11206 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11207 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11208 @end itemize
11209
11210 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11211 @itemize @bullet
11212 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11213 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11214 @example
11215 set $_core 1
11216 #Jc01 packet is sent
11217 print $_core
11218 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11219 @end example
11220
11221 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11222 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11223
11224 @example
11225 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11226 define toggle0
11227 maint packet Jc0
11228 continue
11229 main packet Jc-1
11230 end
11231 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11232 define toggle1
11233 maint packet Jc1
11234 continue
11235 main packet Jc-1
11236 end
11237 @end example
11238 @end itemize
11239
11240 @node Tcl Scripting API
11241 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11242 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11243 @cindex Tcl scripts
11244 @section API rules
11245
11246 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11247 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11248 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11249
11250 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11251 pair list and lists.
11252
11253 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11254 list.
11255
11256 @example
11257 > set foo(me) Duane
11258 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11259 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11260 > set foo(duck) Donald
11261 @end example
11262
11263 If one does this:
11264
11265 @example
11266 > set foo
11267 @end example
11268
11269 The result is:
11270
11271 @example
11272 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11273 @end example
11274
11275 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11276
11277 @verbatim
11278 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11279 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11280 }
11281 @end verbatim
11282
11283 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11284 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11285
11286 @section Internal low-level Commands
11287
11288 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11289 invoke directly.
11290
11291 @itemize @bullet
11292 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11293
11294 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11295 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11296
11297 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11298 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11299
11300 Return information about the flash banks
11301
11302 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11303
11304 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11305 its execution. Example:
11306
11307 @example
11308 > capture "reset init"
11309 @end example
11310
11311 @end itemize
11312
11313 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11314 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11315 called "flash_banks".
11316
11317 @section Tcl RPC server
11318 @cindex RPC
11319
11320 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11321 commands and receive the results.
11322
11323 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11324 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11325 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11326 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11327 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11328
11329 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11330 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11331 @command{capture} command.
11332
11333 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11334
11335 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11336 @cindex RPC Notifications
11337
11338 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11339 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11340
11341 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11342 in the following format.
11343
11344 @verbatim
11345 type target_event event [event-name]
11346 type target_state state [state-name]
11347 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11348 @end verbatim
11349
11350 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11351 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11352 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11353 Defaults to off.
11354
11355 @end deffn
11356
11357 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11358 @cindex RPC trace output
11359
11360 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11361 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11362
11363 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11364
11365 @verbatim
11366 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11367 @end verbatim
11368
11369 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11370 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11371 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11372 Defaults to off.
11373
11374 See an example application here:
11375 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11376
11377 @end deffn
11378
11379 @node FAQ
11380 @chapter FAQ
11381 @cindex faq
11382 @enumerate
11383 @anchor{faqrtck}
11384 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11385 @cindex RTCK
11386 @cindex adaptive clocking
11387 @*
11388
11389 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11390 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11391 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11392 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11393
11394 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11395 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11396 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11397 @enumerate
11398 @item
11399 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11400 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11401 @item
11402 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11403 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11404 @end enumerate
11405
11406 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11407 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11408 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11409 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11410 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11411 power).
11412
11413 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11414 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11415 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11416 ARM926 scenario).
11417 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11418 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11419 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11420
11421 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11422 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11423 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11424 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11425
11426 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11427
11428 In order to make use of this,
11429 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11430 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11431
11432 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11433 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11434 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11435 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11436 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11437
11438 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11439 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11440 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11441 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11442
11443 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11444 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11445 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11446 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11447 with a CPLD.
11448 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11449 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11450 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11451 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11452 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11453 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11454
11455 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11456
11457 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11458
11459 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11460 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11461 depending on the chips on your board.
11462 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11463 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11464 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11465
11466 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11467 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11468 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11469
11470 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11471 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11472 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11473 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11474
11475 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11476 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11477 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11478 this way.
11479
11480 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11481 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11482 clock rate.
11483 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11484 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11485 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11486
11487 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11488
11489 @example
11490 # Example: 1.234MHz
11491 adapter speed 1234
11492 @end example
11493
11494
11495 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11496
11497 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11498 around Windows filenames.
11499
11500 @example
11501 > echo \a
11502
11503 > echo @{\a@}
11504 \a
11505 > echo "\a"
11506
11507 >
11508 @end example
11509
11510
11511 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11512
11513 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11514 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11515 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11516
11517 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11518 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11519 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11520
11521 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11522 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11523 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11524
11525 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11526
11527 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11528 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11529 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11530 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11531
11532 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11533 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11534 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11535
11536 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11537 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11538
11539 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11540 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11541 memory read caused data abort".
11542
11543 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11544 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11545 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11546 be done, feel free to add this here.
11547
11548 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11549 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11550 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11551 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11552 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11553 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11554 gracefully stops.
11555
11556 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11557 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11558 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11559
11560 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11561 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11562 bytes. Painful...
11563
11564
11565 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11566 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11567
11568 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11569 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11570 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11571 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11572 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11573 reset, everything else should work fine.
11574
11575 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11576 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11577 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11578 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11579
11580 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11581 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11582 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11583 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11584
11585 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11586
11587 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11588 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11589 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11590
11591 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11592 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11593
11594 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11595 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11596 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11597 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11598 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11599 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11600 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11601 clock frequency?
11602
11603 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11604 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11605 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11606 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11607 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11608
11609 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11610
11611 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11612 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11613 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11614 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11615 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11616 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11617 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11618
11619 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11620
11621 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11622 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11623 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11624 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11625
11626 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11627 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11628 particular order?
11629
11630 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11631 the same order used by the hardware.
11632
11633 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11634 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11635 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11636 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11637 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11638 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11639
11640 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11641 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11642 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11643 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11644
11645 @itemize @bullet
11646 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11647 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11648 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11649 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11650 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11651 @end itemize
11652
11653 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11654
11655 @itemize @bullet
11656 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11657 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11658 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11659 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11660 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11661 @end itemize
11662
11663
11664 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11665 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11666 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11667
11668 TODO.
11669
11670 @end enumerate
11671
11672 @node Tcl Crash Course
11673 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11674 @cindex Tcl
11675
11676 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11677 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11678 how the Tcl scripts work.
11679
11680 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11681 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11682 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11683 OpenOCD.
11684
11685 @section Tcl Rule #1
11686 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11687 @enumerate
11688 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11689 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11690 @end enumerate
11691
11692 The Tcl equal is this:
11693
11694 @enumerate
11695 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11696 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11697 @end enumerate
11698
11699 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11700 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11701
11702 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11703 There is a second pair of rules.
11704 @enumerate
11705 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11706 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11707 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11708 in Tcl.
11709 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11710 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11711 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11712 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11713 @end enumerate
11714
11715 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11716 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11717 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11718 Everything is a string}
11719
11720 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11721 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11722 difference is subtle.
11723 @enumerate
11724 @item Parse Time
11725 @item Evaluation Time
11726 @end enumerate
11727
11728 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11729 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11730 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11731
11732 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11733 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11734 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11735 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11736
11737 @itemize @bullet
11738 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11739 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11740 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11741 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11742 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11743 @example
11744 # bash example
11745 X=`date`
11746 echo "The Date is: $X"
11747 # Tcl example
11748 set X [date]
11749 puts "The Date is: $X"
11750 @end example
11751 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11752 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11753 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11754 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11755 is a string}
11756 @example
11757 set x "Dinner"
11758 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11759 @end example
11760 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11761 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11762 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11763 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11764 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11765 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11766 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11767 @end itemize
11768
11769 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11770
11771 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11772
11773 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11774
11775 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11776 the normal way.
11777
11778 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11779 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11780 line is immediately executed.
11781
11782 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11783 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11784
11785 @subsection Command Execution
11786
11787 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11788 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11789 control flow operators.
11790
11791 Commands are executed like this:
11792
11793 @enumerate
11794 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11795 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11796 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11797 @end enumerate
11798
11799 It sort of works like this:
11800 @example
11801 for(;;)@{
11802 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11803
11804 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11805
11806 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11807 @}
11808 @end example
11809
11810 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11811 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11812 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11813 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11814 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11815 ``LookupCommand()''
11816
11817 @subsection The FOR command
11818
11819 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11820 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11821 command just like any other command.
11822
11823 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11824 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11825 are:
11826
11827 @enumerate 0
11828 @item The ascii text 'for'
11829 @item The start text
11830 @item The test expression
11831 @item The next text
11832 @item The body text
11833 @end enumerate
11834
11835 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11836 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11837 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11838 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11839
11840 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11841 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11842
11843 @example
11844 int
11845 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11846 int *argc,
11847 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11848 @end example
11849
11850 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11851 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11852 still operates in the same basic way.
11853
11854 @subsection FOR command implementation
11855
11856 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11857 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11858
11859 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11860
11861 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11862
11863 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11864 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11865 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11866
11867 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11868 expression and returns a value.
11869
11870 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11871 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11872 @example
11873 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11874
11875 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11876
11877 int
11878 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11879 int argc,
11880 char **argv )
11881 @{
11882 if( argc != 5 )@{
11883 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11884 return ERROR;
11885 @}
11886
11887 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11888
11889 // Execute the start statement.
11890 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11891
11892 // Top of loop test
11893 for(;;)@{
11894 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11895 if( i == 0 )
11896 break;
11897
11898 // Execute the body
11899 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11900
11901 // Execute the LOOP part
11902 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11903 @}
11904
11905 // Return no error
11906 SetResult( interp, "" );
11907 return SUCCESS;
11908 @}
11909 @end example
11910
11911 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11912 in the same basic way.
11913
11914 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11915
11916 @subsection source and find commands
11917 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11918 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11919 @*Remember the parsing rules
11920 @enumerate
11921 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11922 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11923 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11924 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11925 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11926 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11927 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11928 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11929 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11930 @end enumerate
11931 @subsection format command
11932 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11933 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11934 @b{sprintf()}.
11935 @b{Example}
11936 @example
11937 set x 6
11938 set y 7
11939 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11940 @end example
11941 @enumerate
11942 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11943 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11944 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11945 @* Refer to Rule #1
11946 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11947 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11948 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11949 @end enumerate
11950 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11951 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11952 @example
11953 #1 Good
11954 proc someproc @{@} @{
11955 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11956 @}
11957 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11958 #2 Good - no variables
11959 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11960 #3 Good Curly Braces
11961 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11962 puts "Time: [date]"
11963 @}
11964 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11965 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11966 @end example
11967 @enumerate
11968 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11969 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11970 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11971 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11972 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11973 command.
11974 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11975 @*There are 4 examples:
11976 @enumerate
11977 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11978 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11979 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11980 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11981 @end enumerate
11982
11983 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11984 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11985 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11986
11987 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11988 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11989 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11990 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11991 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11992 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11993 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11994 @end enumerate
11995 @subsection Global Variables
11996 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11997 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11998 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11999 @example
12000 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12001 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12002 global x #Global variable X
12003 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12004 @}
12005 @end example
12006 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12007 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12008 @example
12009 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12010 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12011 # Create var name
12012 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12013 # Make it a global
12014 global $vn
12015 # Set it.
12016 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12017 @}
12018 @end example
12019 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12020 @example
12021 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12022 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12023 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12024 @}
12025 @end example
12026
12027 @node License
12028 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12029 @include fdl.texi
12030
12031 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12032 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12033 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12034 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12035 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12036 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12037
12038 @printindex cp
12039
12040 @node Command and Driver Index
12041 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12042 @printindex fn
12043
12044 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)